Open access JTBSRR Journal of Today’s Biological Sciences : Research & Review (JTBSRR) ISSN 2320-1444 (Online) Published on : 30.12.2012 1 Welcome Message from Editor-in-Chief It gives me a great pleasure to welcome you to the inaugural issue of The Journal “Journal of Today’s Biological Sciences: Research & Review”. It is my expectation this journal will give our young generation a field to share their knowledge with renowned biologists of different parts of the world that will move us forward intellectually. I wish to extend my gratitude to the members of the Advisory and Editorial Board as they are the backbone of this scientific endeavor. We could not make it possible to start this journal without the support and professionalism of scientists interested in biological sciences and wish to make this journal a success. I would like to emphasize the compelling reasons for launching a new open-access journal in this ever expanding area of research, as well as our aspirations and vision for the future. I believe that it is important to have a journal which gives free access to its contents and promotes high-quality research and intellectual output of scientists who have limited access to the journals which cannot provide free access. We aim at bridging the gap so that the authors get a wider audience for their high-quality scientific achievements. Thus we will work in partnership with such authors to ensure that their research is made freely available to the wider scientific community. I believe we will be able to publish a significant number of high-quality original research article and scientific reviews from authors all around the world. The Journal invites manuscripts in the areas of zoology, botany, biotechnology, microbiology, biochemistry, molecular biology, pharmacy, veterinary sciences agricultural sciences, environmental sciences, fisheries and aquatic Sciences – a broad-based theme that should appeal to the largest possible audience interested in this subject. I look forward to the publication of the first issue of our journal and thereby welcome valuable comments and suggestions that would improve the Journal in future. Dr. Debashri Mondal Editor –in- Chief Journal of Today’s Biological Sciences: Research & Review (JTBSRR) 1 2 Journal of Today’s Biological Sciences: Research & Review (JTBSRR) ISSN 2320-1444 (Online) JTBSRR Vol.1, Issue 1, page 2-15, December 30, 2012 Available on: www.jtbsrr.in Development of Byproduct and Nutritious Food Industry Waste-Based Low-Cost Fish Feed Santosh Zargar, G.V. Mulmuley and Tarun Kanti Ghosh* National Environmental Engineering Research Institute, Nehru Marg, Nagpur–440 020 Email: tk_ghosh@neeri.res.in; ghoshtk2@rediffmail.com Abstract Feed is one of the major inputs in aquaculture, and the success of fish farming depends primarily on the provision of adequate quantity of nutritionally balanced feed in a form, acceptable to fish. Under the present investigation, four diets (feeds I, II, III and IV) were formulated using commonly available grains (maize and soybean), nutritious wastes (poultry and silkworm) and a by-product (de-oiled rice bran). Experiments were conducted to evaluate acceptability of different formulated diets by Indian major carp Catla catla in plastic pools. The values of NWG, PER and FCE were found in the order: Feed V > Feed II > Feed III > Feed I > Feed IV. Feed V, made of nutritionally rich costly ingredients, was procured from CIFE. The outcome of a field trial, using feeds II and IV separately on brood fish in natural ponds, resulted in 100 percent increased growth with feed II over those fed by conventional feed (feed IV). The cost of the feed II was estimated to be around two-third of the similar kind of feed, available in the market. The study could provide the technology to local people for their employment generation, pollution free environment by utilizing nutritious waste materials in the fish feed and minimization of incorporating presently practiced grains in fish feed, so that paucity of food grains in developing countries can be partially solved. Keywords: Formulation, Byproduct, Nutritious Waste, Fish Feed, Catla catla 2 3 Introduction Fish, like any other animal, require nutrients to remain healthy and active for which nutrients play a vital role. Nutrients can be provided by various types of food items, which are determined both by the feeding behavior or preference of the animal and the availability of items. Growth and/or net nutrition deposition is the most accurate and important tool in studying fish feed efficiency and nutrient requirements (Das et al., 1991). Feed is one of the major inputs in aquaculture, and the success of fish farming depends primarily on the provision of adequate quantity of nutritionally balanced feed in a form, which is acceptable to fish. The traditional feed, presently used in composite fish culture of carps, comprises of rice bran and groundnut/soybean oilcake in equal proportions. These are being used only as supplementary feeds and the availability of natural protein in the form of plankton is essential. The shortcoming of such feeds in terms of quality becomes obvious when the plankton availability in the pond is insufficient. Moreover, traditional feed lacks desired levels of protein, carbohydrate, vitamins and minerals. Since the livestock, especially poultry, pig and fish compete with humans for high quality protein; the demand for grains and cereals is high. Developing countries face nearly 50% deficiency in concentrated feed which is expected to increase further in forthcoming years (www.tifac.org.in/offer/tlbo/rep/ TMS162.htm). This deficiency in food production can be removed only when there are alternate feed resources for reducing the composition of crop products in the animal feed and substituting these with unconventional ingredients like nutritionally rich waste materials. In view of this, the use of animal waste or its content in fish feed needs to be enhanced. This will not only reduce the consumption of grains but also increase the nutritional value of feedstuff. The animal tissues contain numerous proteolytic enzymes, which help in increasing the digestibility of the feed. Fish feed products are mostly based on ingredients derived from crop residues. On the other hand, vast resources of slaughterhouse/poultry/silkworm byproducts, which are termed as wastes and are rich in proteins and minerals, are freely available in plenty in most of the countries. Utilization of these so called waste materials in the production of fish feeds will not only solve the problem of nutritional needs of fish but also help in reducing environmental pollution, caused by the discarded animal tissues, scattered all over the rural as well as urban areas, leading to public nuisance and vector breeding centers. 3 4 The present study aimed at formulating fish feeds, comprising of byproduct and nutritious food industry waste-based materials and also to improve the quality of conventional feed, used by pisciculturists. The study could provide a technology to local people for their employment generation; provide a pollution free environment by preventing scattered nutritious waste materials; conversion of waste to wealth and a solution to minimize incorporation of grains in fish feed by replacing these with waste materials, thereby partially solving the problem of grain paucity in developing countries. Materials & Methods Fish Feed Formulation& Preparation Feed formulation is the process of designing a mixture that will meet the nutritional requirement of the animal while taking into account certain practical consideration (acceptability of mixture to the animal, ability of the mixture to be pelleted, cost, etc.). The four prepared diets (feeds I, II, III, IV) were formulated using locally available ingredients and nutritious wastes as shown in Table 1. Table 1. Percent composition of ingredients used for preparing feeds Ingredients Feed I Feed II Feed III (%) (%) (%) Feed IV (%) Soybean 35.0 45.0 35.0 - Rice bran 30.0 15.0 30.0 50.0 DOC Soybean - - - 50.0 Maize Powder 10.0 10.0 10.0 - Bakery waste 14.0 14.0 14.0 - Poultry waste - 5.0 - - Silk-worm waste - 5.0 5.0 - 0.1 0.1 0.1 - 5.0 5.0 5.0 - Vitamin mineral mixture Starch (binder) 4 5 For preparation of pelleted fish feed, the equipments, like Pulverizer, Extruder and Packaging machine (Fig. 1 to 3) were used. Corn starch (50 g) was boiled at 100oC with 250 ml water and was mixed with grinded ingredients. Grinding increases the nutrient availability of feed, and reduced particle size augments activity of proteolytic enzyme released during tissue grinding. As a pretreatment, the soybean seeds were soaked (overnight: 6 hours) in water, blanched (boiling water: 20 minutes), de-husked and sun-dried. The treatment destroyed trypsin inhibitors of soybean meal, thus increasing its nutritional value. Nutritious wastes, viz. poultry, slaughter house and silkworm, were cleaned and sun-dried before processing. Dough was prepared and extruded through 2 mm diameter die of a hand operated Extruder. The extruded moist noodles were sun-dried for a day, pelletized manually, graded by using sieves, and then stored in airtight jars/polythene bags at room temperature. Proximate analysis of major ingredients was undertaken in the laboratory following the method of Association of Official Analytical Chemists (Anonymous, 1980). A balanced feed (Feed V) comprising of soybean, fish meal, corn meal, coconut oil, wheat flour, cod liver oil, sunflower seed, CMC binder and vitamin C at 44, 10, 4.5, 9.5, 4.5, 2.0, 2.0, 2.0 and 0.1 percent respectively was procured from Central Institute of Fisheries Education (CIFE), a deemed University in Mumbai. The crude fat levels in feeds I through V were 12.2, 12.8, 13.7, 9.7 and 9.0 percent respectively. Fig. 1. Pulveriser used for grinding the feed ingredients Fig. 2. Hand operated Extruder used to make pellets Fig. 3. Packaging machine for sealing the packed feed Design of experiment Experiment was designed to determine the acceptability of different formulated diets by select fish (Catla catla). The fish (average weight 20+ 2.0 g) were procured 5 6 from Mansar hatchery farm, Nagpur (Maharashtra, India) and were acclimatised in experimental condition for a week. Experiment was conducted in triplicate in plastic tanks of 500 L capacity. Each tank was stocked with fifteen fishes. Prior to the commencement of experiment, the pools were thoroughly cleaned, filled with water and stocked with pre weighed acclimatized fish fingerlings. Special care was taken to avoid escape of the fish during the experiment. The feeding experiment was conducted for 30 days. In order to maintain the water quality as good as possible, about one third water from each tank was replaced by dechlorinated tap water every morning. Since feeding frequency plays an important role on growth, the fish were fed once a day at the rate of 2% of body weight throughout the experiment. Any uneaten food and fecal matter from each pool were removed daily by siphoning method. Dietary Performance Evaluation Relevant water quality parameters, viz. temperature, pH, hardness, alkalinity and DO were analysed (APHA, 2005) during the experiment on alternate days. Dietary performances were evaluated through following nutritional indices (Rajan et al., 1996). Net Weight Gain percent (NWG percent) = (Initial weight/ Final weight) x 100 Specific Growth Rate (SGR) = [ (Log final weight - Log initial weight)/ Number of days] x 100 Feed Conversion Ratio (FCR) = Amount of dry feed provided/ Live weight gain Protein Efficiency Ratio (PER) = Gain in body weight/ Protein intake Food Conversion Efficiency (FCE) = Wet weight gain/ Dry weight of feed given Note: All weights are expressed in gram Results and Discussion Water Quality The water characteristics during the study period were in the ranges: pH 7.8 + 0.2 to 8.0 + 0.2; alkalinity (mgL-1) 256.1 + 9.5 to 276.2 + 3.4; dissolved oxygen (mgL-1) 5.3 + 0.5 to 6.0 + 0.4; and total hardness (mgL-1) 120 +5.0 to 136 + 6.0. Since fish are poikilotherm, water temperature plays an important role in energy partitioning, protein assimilation and growth (Swamy and Devraj, 1994). Water temperature varied from 23.8 + 4.0 to 26.7 + 0.5oC. The results of water quality parameters were within the recommended (CIFE, 2003) ranges for aquaculture JTBSRR 1(1): 2-15, 2012 ISSN 2320-1444 6 7 practices (pH: 6.7-9.5; alkalinity: 50-300 mgL-1; dissolved oxygen: 5-10 mgL-1 and total hardness: 30-180 mgL-1). It appears that the growth of fish was not influenced by the variations recorded in abiotic parameters of water during the experiment. Dietary Performance Growth, in terms of net weight gain, was maximum (50.0 ± 5.0 percent) in fish feed V and least in feed IV (13.3 ± 1.0 percent) during the study period (P< 0.05) (Table 2). SGR, PER and FCE were also highest in fish feed V (0.61, 2.77 and 83.33 respectively, Table 2). SGR can be considered as an index of growth evaluation of diets; however, higher FCE signifies better utilization of the consumed matter. FCR (1.20) and PER (0.85) were found to be less for fish feeds V and IV respectively as compared to other fish feeds. FCR values were found to vary from 1.20 (feed V, 30.0 percent protein) to 4.5 (feed IV, 26.2 percent protein) in different diets. Earlier, Choudhury et al. (2002) reported varying FCRs from 1.29 to 1.95 in different formulated diets and at different feeding frequencies. Obviously, different authors reported varied FCR values on different fishes, such as, 1.12 to 1.35 for Cyprinus carpio with formulated diet (38.74% protein level) at five times feeding (Capper et al., 1982), 3.68 to 3.82 for L. rohita (23.9% protein level) in cages (Ahmed et al., 1983) and 3.08 in L. rohita for diet containing 33.92% protein (Rangacharyulu et al., 1991). Even though theses feeds were not wastebased, the values were comparable to the findings of the present study. A superior growth performance was noted in fish, fed with feed I as compared to those on feed IV in spite of the lower protein content (23.1 percent) in the former. This observation draws attention to two essential inferences; viz. the crude protein percent in feed IV might be having higher content of indigestible protein and lower crude lipid percentage in feed IV might have played a crucial role in feed utilization. The values of NWG, PER, and FCE were found in the order: Feed V > Feed II > Feed III > Feed I > Feed IV. The minimum growth was found in fish, fed with feed IV, which contained rice bran and DOC soybean (50:50 percent). There was no mortality of fish during the period of experiment conducted. The results indicated that animal-based fish feeds like poultry and silkworm (feed II) and silkworm (feed III) wastes were digested efficiently and were comparable to balanced fish feed (V) than the other feeds (I and IV). 7 8 Table 2. Feed utilization parameters selected for assessment of the feeds Diet NWG SGR FCR PER FCE 26.7 0.33 2.25 1.90 44.44 Feed II 46.7 0.56 1.28 2.8 77.77 Feed III 33.3 0.44 1.80 2.04 55.55 Feed IV 13.3 0.19 4.5 0.85 22.22 Feed V 50.0 0.61 1.20 2.77 83.33 (%) Feed I In the present study, one byproduct (rice bran) and three types of nutritious wastes, viz. bakery, poultry and silkworm were used. Studies revealed that growth rate of fish, grown on feed II is comparable to those of feed V (P> 0.05). Considering cost involved in feed V, subsequently field trial was given in natural ponds. While composition details of the byproduct/wastes are mentioned in Table 3, proximate and amino acid compositions of low-cost fish feed II (Fig. 4.), based on byproduct and nutritious industry wastes are presented in Tables 4 and 5. The feed comprises of soybean (45 percent), rice bran (15 percent), maize (10 percent), bakery waste (14 percent), poultry waste (5 percent), silk worm waste (5 percent), vitamin mineral mix (0.1 percent) and starch (5 percent). Table 3: Nutrient values of byproduct and wastes used for the study Sl. No. Parameters 1 2 3 4 5 Rice bran 15.3 15.92 Silkworm waste 54.2 30.3 Protein (%) Fat (%) Crude fibre 8.44 3.9 (%) Ash (%) 6.7 5.2 Carbohydrate 53.64 6.4 (%) Poultry waste 59.9 17.1 Bakery waste 10.7 12.7 2.1 0.4 15.5 3.8 5.4 72.4 The nutritious rice bran, being rich in protein and having better amino acid profile, is produced in great quantities as a by-product of the rice milling 8 9 industries. Further, the wastes from poultry/silkworm/bakery are better sources of proteins and minerals, and are also available at almost freely in developing countries. Maize is a relatively poor cereal, although it possesses limiting amounts of two essential amino acids, viz. lysine and tryptophan (Hanifa et al., 1987). Fig. 4. Pellets of recommended Fish Feed II Among the protein sources of plant origin, soybean (Glycine max) is reported to have greater value as fish feed ingredient because of its easy availability, better chemical composition, amino acid balance and relatively low cost (Takeshi and Juadee, 1993). However, soybean was found deficient in two essential amino acids- lysine and methionine (Viola, 1982), and is also known to have certain anti-nutritional factor, responsible for growth depression (Wilson and Poe, 1985). Studies on Essential Amino Acid (EAA) requirement of Indian major carps were conducted using synthetic diets. Singh et al. (1986) observed that maximum total EAA level required in the synthetic diet for rohu fry was 27.4 percent, of which 1.58 percent was methionine along with cystine, and 3.83 percent was lysine. These are very similar to that used by Nose et al. (1974) for common carp, where total maximum EAA was 28.95 percent having methionine and cystine 1.76 percent and lysine 3.57 percent. This indicated that EAA requirement of rohu might be very similar to common carp. Developed feeds possess required vitamins and minerals (Table 4). It may be added that vitamin requirements of fishes are dependent on size, age and growth rate of fishes, besides environmental factors and nutrients. However, vitamin E (Tocopherol) protects highly unsaturated fatty acids in lipids of biological membranes from oxidation in the presence of molecular oxygen, and both water- 9 10 Table 4. Proximate analysis of recommended fish feed (Feed II) Sl. No. Parameters Values 1 Moisture, % by wt. 6.0 2 Total ash, % by wt. 5.7 3 Protein, % by wt. (N x 6.25) 29.5 4 Fat,% by wt. 11.3 5 Crude fibre, % by wt. 5.5 6 Carbohydrates (by difference)*, % by wt. 42.0 7 Calorific value*, (K.cals/100gm) 388 9 Vitamin B1 , mg/100gm 0.2 10 Vitamin B2, mg/100gm 0.6 11 Vitamin C, mg/100g 3.1 12 Tocopherols, mg/100gm 13.2 13 Calcium, mg/100gm 35.1 14 Chromium, mg/100gm Below detection limit of 0.05 15 Copper, mg/100gm 1.6 16 Iron, mg/100gm 18.0 17 Magnesium, mg/100gm 484 18 Manganese, mg/100gm 9.6 19 Potassium, mg/100gm 2094 20 Sodium, mg/100gm 87.2 21 Zinc, mg/100gm 18.1 22 Phosphorus, mg/100gm 773 23 Chlorides, % by wt. (as NaCl) 0.9 * Carbohydrates (by difference) =100 - (moisture + total ash + protein + fat + crude fiber); calorific value (kcal/100gm) = (4 x protein %) + (4 x carbohydrates %) + (9 x fat %) 10 11 Table 5. Amino acid composition of recommended fish feed (Feed II) Sl. Parameters Values 1 Aspartic acid 8.49 + 0.34 2 Glutamic acid 18.86 + 0.07 3 Serine (Ser) 3.82 + 0.25 4 Glycine(Gly) 4.97 ± 0.05 5 Histidine (His) 2.48+0.05 6 Arginine (Arg) 6.95 + 0.14 7 Threonine (Thr) 3.72 + 0.12 8. Alanine(Ala) 3.97 + 0.09 9 Proline (Pro) 6.76 + 0.02 10 Tyrosine (Tyr) 0.82 + 0.04 11 Valine (Val) 5.57 + 0.08 12 Isoleucine (He) 5.49 + 0.22 13 Leucine (Leu) 9.05 + 0.12 14 Phenylalanine (Phe) 5.03 + 0.06 15 Lysine (Lys) 5.43 + 0.07 16 Cysteic 6.73 + 0.55 17 Methionine 1.87 + 0.07 No. 11 12 soluble and fat-soluble vitamins are required for healthy growth of mrigal (Cirrhina mrigala) and rohu (Labeo rohita). The growth rate of rohu fingerlings was found to be significantly increased on addition of water-soluble and fat-soluble vitamins (Singh et al., 1986). Four fat-soluble and eleven water-soluble vitamins and vitamin-like compounds are essential to fish. Minerals play a great role within the animal body. Minerals are important nutrients as these are required for normal bone, tissue, blood plasma and hemoglobin formations and also for many enzymatic reactions. Calcium (Ca) and Phosphorus (P) are required for the formation of skeletal tissues. Fishes absorb a good quantity of calcium from water and rest from diet but most of the phosphorus should be provided through diet. For common carp, the minimum requirement of calcium in diet is about 0.028 percent and that of phosphorus is 0.6–0.7 percent. Trace elements, required in traces, are growth stimulants. Elements like manganese, copper, iron, cobalt, iodine and zinc are required in minute quantities in balanced ration, mainly for improving protein assimilation and survival rates (Das and Kaviraj, 1994)). Since fish obtain minerals from their diet and also from the environment, it may be mentioned that all the desired minerals and trace metals at specific levels are available in recommended fish feed II (Table 4). Feeding Trial by Fishery Department In order to assess the quality of the developed feed (II) in natural condition and also to have views from State Fishery Department on the feed, experiment was conducted in natural ponds for 52 days by District Fisheries Department, Bhandara (DFDB, Maharashtra, India). For this purpose, 100 kg feed was provided to DFDB for conducting experiment on two varieties of brood fish ( Labeo rohita and Catla catla: 10 nos. each) in two natural ponds (area: each of 51 x 26 x 1m) at fish hatchery farm, located in Iteadoh, District Gondia, using two different types of feed (feed II and conventional feed, that is, mixture of rice bran and oil cake) in respective ponds. Both the feeds were dispensed into the respective ponds measuring at three percent of total fish body weight per day during the experiment. The studies revealed that the increase of growth of fish, fed by feed II was doubled over those, fed by conventional feed. Further, the release of eggs, after artificial breeding, was eleven percent more in fish, grown on feed II. However, hatching rate was 65 percent in both the cases. Considering better result in natural ponds, it is recommended to adopt the composition of feed II as ingredients of low-cost feed, and convert waste to fish flesh. Evaluation of Cost & Quality It may be mentioned that production cost of the developed feed (Indian Rs. 25/per kg or around US Dollar 0.55 per kg) is about two-third or less of the similar kind of feed, available in the market. The cost of the feed procured from CIFE 12 13 was higher, since none of the ingredients (soybean 44 percent, fish meal 10 percent, corn meal 4.5 percent, coconut oil 9.5 percent, wheat flour 4.5 percent, cod liver oil 2.0 percent, sunflower seed 2.0 percent, CMC binder 2.0 percent and vitamin C 0.1 percent) are wastes. It may be added that a byproduct is a secondary and incidental product from a manufacturing process and is not the primary product. A byproduct or waste can be procured at a reduced price or free of cost, and be used as raw material of other product. The cost of feed for prawns/shrimps is still higher. The cost of the developed feed was substantially reduced by incorporating animal wastes and byproducts, instead of costly ingredients, which are normally used in prevailing feed industry. In order to avoid exorbitant cost of marketed fish feeds, farmers commonly use traditional feed, comprising of agro products like rice bran and groundnut/soybean oilcake. As per normal practice, a mixture (50:50) of the feed is spread over the pond for feeding the fish. In such cases, most of the feed is settled at the bottom and are unused. Moreover, by this method fish do not get balanced feed, required for their growth and reproduction. The large entrepreneurs often use costly feed, made of agro products, viz. maize, soybean, corn meal, coconut oil, wheat flour, sunflower seed etc. This enhances the cost of the feed, resulting in non-acceptance of fish feed pellets by economically poor farmers. In the present study, agro products/byproduct were supplemented to improve the quality of the conventional feed. The invented pelletized fish feed has essential nutrients for proper growth of fish. Conclusion Present study dealt with different formulated fish feeds using select byproduct and nutritious food industry waste based materials. The cost of the developed feed, comprising of soybean (45 percent), rice bran (15 percent), maize (10 percent), bakery waste (14 percent), poultry waste (5 percent), silk worm waste (5 percent), vitamin mineral mix (0.1 percent) and starch (5 percent) has been worked out to be about two-third of the similar kind of feed, available in the market. The study could provide the technology to local people for their employment generation, pollution free environment due to utilization of scattered nutritious waste materials in the form of fish feed and solution to minimize the incorporation of grains in fish feed by replacing these with nutritious industry waste materials leading to scope in solving the problem of grain paucity in developing countries. 13 14 Acknowledgements The authors are grateful to the Director NEERI, Nagpur for infrastructure facilities, to Dr. T. Chakrabarti, Scientist H, NEERI, Nagpur for helpful suggestions and Mr. R. L. Lonkar, DFDO, Bhandara for onsite experimental support during the investigation. We acknowledge the financial support from Department of Biotechnology(DBT sanction No.: BT/PR4284/SPD/09/333/2003) New Delhi, Government of India. References Ahmed, G.U., Haque, A.K.M., Islam, M.A. & Haque, M.M., 1983. Intensive culture of Labeo rohita (Hamilton) in floating ponds with special references to different stocking densities. Bangladesh. J. Fish., 6:11-17. American Public Health Association, APHA, 2005. Standard Methods of examination of water and wastewater, Washington DC. Anonymous, 1980. Official Methods of Analysis of Association of Official Analytical Chemists, 13th Ed., W. Hertiz, Washington, DC. Capper, B.S., Wood, J.F. & Jackson, A.J., 1982. The feeding value for carp of two types of mustard oil cakes from Nepal. Aquaculture, 29:373-377. Choudhury, B. B. P., Das, D. R., Ibrahim, M. & Chakraborty, S. C. 2002. Relationship between feeding frequency and growth of one Indian major carp Labeo rohita (ham.) fingerlings fed on different formulated diets. Pakistan J. Biol. Sci., v. 5/10, pp. 1120-1122. CIFE (2003). A course manual on Biochemical Technology in Fisheries, Central Institute of Fisheries Education (CIFE), Mumbai. Das, B.K. & Kaviraj, A., 1994. Influence of Potassium Permanganate, Cobalt Chloride, and Dietary Supplement of Vitamin B Complex on the Histopathological Changes in Gill Epithelium of Common Carp Exposed to Cadmium. Progres. Fish-Cult., 56:265-268. Das, K.M., Mohanty & Sarkar, S., 1991. Optimum dietary protein to energy ratio for Labeo rohita fingerlings. (In S.S. Silva (Ed.), Fish Nutrition- Research, AsiaProceedings of the fourth Asian Fish Nutrition Workshop (pp 69-73). India). 14 15 Hanifa, M.A., Murugesan, A.G. & Fleming, A.T. 1987. Influence of plant animal food on food utilization of the freshwater carp Labeo rohita (Ham.). Curr. Sci., 56:846-848. Nose, T.S., Arai, D.L. & Hashimoto, Y. 1974. A note on amino acids essential for growth of young carp. Bull. Japan. Soc. Sci. Fish. 40:903–908. Rajan, M.R., Thilijath, B. & Thilagavathy, D., 1996. Feed utilization and growth of Cyprinus carpio var communis in relation to different protein levels. Environ. Ecol. 14: 60-66. Rangachoryulu, P.V., Sarkar, S., Mohanty, S.N. & Mukhopadhyay, P.K. (1991). Growth and protein utilization in rohu (Labeo rohita) under different feeding levels. National Symposium on New Horizons in Freshwater. Aquaculture, 95-97. Singh, B.N., Singh, V.R.P., Kumar, K. & Swamy, D.N. 1986. Observations on the feed formulations and fortification of conventional fish feed for rohu and mrigal fingerlings. Int. J. Acad. Ichthyol., 7:31-34. Swamy Vijaykumar, H.V. & Devraz, K.V. 1994. Growth response to fry of the fish Catla catla fed on three formulated feeds. Environ. Ecol., 12/3:519-523. Takeshi, W. & Juadee, P. 1993. Potential of Soybean meal as protein source in extruded pellets for Rainbow Trout. Nippon Suisan Gakkaishi., 59/8: 1415-1423. Viola, S. 1982. Partial and complete replacement of fish meal by soybean meal in feeds for intensive culture of carp. Aquaculture, 26:223-226. Wilson, R.P. & Poe, W.E. 1985. Effects of feeding soybean meal with varying trypsin inhibitor activities on growth of fingerling channel catfish. Aquaculture, 46:19-25. 15 16 Journal of Today’s Biological Sciences: Research & Review (JTBSRR) ISSN 2320-1444 (Online) JTBSRR Vol.1, Issue 1, page 16-19, December 30, 2012 Available on: www.jtbsrr.in Ethno-Botanical Investigation on Important Wild Edible Herbs of Siliguri Subdivision of Darjeeling District, West Bengal, India Tamal Mondal Assistant Professor, Department of Botany, Netaji Mahavidyalaya, Arambagh, Hooghly, West Bengal, India, Email- tamalmondal1@gmail.com Abstract The present study deals with the identification and ethno-botanical investigation with respect to food value of wild edible herbs from Siliguri Subdivision Area. A total number of 19 plants belonging to 15 families are found as wild edible herbs. Edible herbs are not only delicious but also important for their nutritional value as well as their medicinal poperties.Special steps should be taken for this cheap source of natural food for a better tomorrow. Key words: Ethno-botany, wild edible herbs, food source, cheap diet, nutritional value Introduction Plants are source of food since ancient times. Wild plants serve an important role to fulfillment of the diet of local habitat. Wild edible plants are not only important for their food quality but also a large contribution to the population’s nutrition throughout the year (Sasi and Rajendran, 2012; Katewa, 2003; Grivetti and Ogle Britta, 2000; FAO, 1999).Now a days wild edible plants play an important role as a cheap source of valuable food. To identify the wild edible herbs, a short investigation has been done in the area of Siliguri Subdivision, the foot hills of Darjeeling Himalaya. It was found that 19 wild plants belonging to 15 families are used, collected, marketed, and cooked as vegetables by the local communities. 16 17 Materials & Methods The study area, Siliguri Subdivision is situated at 26º43´N latitude and 88º25´E longitude within Darjeeling District of West Bengal,India.The Subdivision contains 22 gram panchayats(rural area) under four community development blocks; Matigara,Naxalbari,Phansidewa,and Kharibari, including SMC(Siliguri Municipal Corporation).During this field trips to the rural area as well as urban market place the wild edible herbs were collected and enlisted and also their uses were recorded through questionnaires with the local poor people, and tribes related with those wild edible herbs, specially older and aged people of this Subdivision.The collected specimens were preserved as a voucher specimen for further identification by standard herbarium technique (Jain and Rao,1977).Next crucial step is to proper identification of the collected herbs, for this authentic literature (Prain,1963; Bennet,1987) were used to do so. Results and Discussion The wild edible herbs of Siliguri Subdivision,their scientific name,family in which they belongs,their local names along with their edible portion as well as their medicinal properties are presented in table 1. Table 1. List of collected wild edible herbs of Siliguri Subdivision Sl. No. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Scientific Name Amaranthus tricolor Amaranthus viridis L. Amorphophallu s muelleri BI. Bacopa monnieri (L.) Pennell Brassica Campestris L. var.cuneifolia Roxb Cannabis sativa L. Centella asiatica (L.) Family Amaranthaceae Amaranthaceae Araceae Local Name Lal sak Bon notey Ool Edible parts Leaves plant Medicinal Uses Shikness,cou gh and cold Whole plants Piles,shikness Scrophulariacea e Bramhi Leaves,Rhizo me Leaves Cruciferae Lai sak Whole plants Cough cold Cannabinaceae Vang Leaves Pain relief Apiaceae Thankuni Whole plants 17 Blood purifier Memory loss, ill health and Diarrhea and Dysentery 18 8. Chenopodium album L. Chinopodiaceae Bethua sak Whole plants Digestive problems 9. Coccinia cordifolia W. & A. Colocasia esculenta Schott. Enhydra fluctuans Lour. Glinus oppisitifolius (L.) A.DC. Hygrophila schulli (BuchHam.) M.R.et S.M.Almeida Ipomoea aquatica Forsk. Cucurbitaceae Kudru Fruits Araceae Kochu Whole plants Digestive problems,dys entry Blood purifier, Asteraceae Helancha /Hincha Gima sak Leaves Acanthaceae Kulekhar a Whole plants Shikness,pain reliever Convolvulaceae Kalmi sak Whole plants Blood purifier, 15. Luffa cylindrica (L.) Roem. Cucurbitaceae Dhudul Fruits Digestive problems 16. Marsilea quadrifolia L. Mentha arvensis L. Marsileaceae Susni sak Leaves Skin troubles Lamiaceae Pudina Whole plants Digestive problems 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 17. Aizoaceae Whole plants Skin diseases, insomnia Cough and cold, fever 18. Nymphaea alba Nymphaeaceae L. Saluk Leaf petiole Bleeding problems 19. Typhonium trilobatum Schott. Kharkon kachu Leaves Blood purifier Araceae Conclusion These types of field trips are extremely necessary for proper documentation of wild edible plants of natural origin. These plants are gifted by our mother nature, and a vast research is required towards the proper use of this plants. 18 19 Acknowledgement I am very much thankful to Prof.B.N.Mondal,(Retd.),Shivmandir,Siliguri,West bengal for his kind help and suggestion for preparation of this manuscript. References Bennet,S.S.R. 1987 .Name Changes in Flowering Plants of India and Adjacent Regions,Triseas Publishers,Dehra Dun,India. FAO (1999) .Use and potential of wild plants. (Information Division,Food and Agricultural Organization of the United Nations,Rome,Italy). Jain, S.K.and Rao, R.R.1977.A hand book of field and herbarium methods,Today and Tomorrow’s Printers and Publishers, New Delhi and Calcutta. L.E.Grivetti and M.Olga Britta (2000).Value of traditional foods in meeting macro-micronutrient needs: the wild plant connection .Natl Res.Rev. 13:31-46. Mondal,T. (2012).Survey of some important ethno-medicinal plants of Siliguri Subdivision,Darjeeling,West Bengal.Life sciences Leaflets 8 :24-27 ,2012. Prain, D.1996.Bengal Plants (Vol 1 & 2),Bishen Singh Mahendra Pal Singh, Dehra Dun ,India. S.S.Katewa (2003).Contribution of some wild food plants from forestry to the diet of tribal of Southern Rajasthan.Ind.Forest.129 (9): 1117-1131. Sasi,R. and A.Rajendran (2012).Diversity of wild fruits in Nilgiri hills of the Southern Westran Ghats –Ethnobotanical aspects.IJABPT ,Vol 3 issue 1,82-87. 19 20 Journal of Today’s Biological Sciences: Research & Review (JTBSRR) ISSN 2320-1444 (Online) JTBSRR Vol.1, Issue 1, page 20-27, December 30, 2012 Available on: www.jtbsrr.in Application of Solar Energy for Semiprocessing of Curcuma Longa (Haldi) and Maranta Arundinacea (Arrowroot) as a Source of Additional Livelihood and Entrepreneur Activity in the Selected Villages of Phanda Block of Bhopal District Padma Harshan, Madhavi Muchrikar, Uttam Nagwanshi and Manoj Chourasiya Society for Human Welfare & Environmental Furtherance (SHWEF) Plot No.277, F-4, A Sector, Sarvadharma Colony, Kolar Road, Bhopal 462 042, Madhya Pradesh, INDIA. E. mail- shwef267@gmail.com, shwef17@rediffmail.com Abstract India has a major agribusiness sector, which has achieved remarkable successes over the last three and a half decades. The right post harvest practices such as good processing techniques, and proper packaging; transportation and storage (of even processed foods) can play a significant role in reducing spoilage and extending shelf life. The Indian Government has formulated Vision 2015, to triple the size of the food processing industry, from the current $ 70 b to around $ 210 b, enhancing her global share to 3%, increasing value addition to 35%, from the current 20% and raising the level of processing of perishables to 20%. There are about 300 clear sunny days in most parts of the country. Solar energy4 can supply and/or supplement many farm energy requirements.Our project catalyzed and supported by the Ministry of Science and Technology, SSD, New Delhi, on non chemical farming methods of Curcuma longa (turmeric)1 and Maranta arundinacea (arrowroot) in Dehrikalan village of Phanda block of Bhopal, M.P. has given a ray of hope that on a very small and pilot scale the agricultural applications of solar use for semi processing can be demonstrated to the beneficiary partners by various means to understand the importance of the same thereby opening new doors to generate employment opportunities with enhanced income to rural youth both men and woman to learn and take up trainings. More importantly, the 20 21 income generated out this enterprise will keep circling within the local economy and open new marketing channels for the young rural entrepreneurs. Keywords: Demonstration, solar equipments, semi processing, additional livelihood, rural entrepreneur. Introduction Agriculture is the backbone of Indian economy, contributing about 29.1 per cent towards GDP, providing livelihood to about 65 to 70 per cent of population and nearly 20 per cent of export earnings. It should be made a remunerative option. The vibrant agriculture markets including derivatives markets are the frontline institutions to provide sign of future prospect of the sector. Under the current situation it is better that farmers shift to organic farming in large areas. Globally, organic foods are in great demand under the changing lifestyle. Organic seal implies no use of pesticides. As the organic quality assurance in India is still at the nascent stage, it is useful to learn from the International arena. India's food processing industry is expected to benefit from this and grow to around $260-billion from the present USD 200-billion in the next 6-years, according to industry expert. In India, only 6% of total agro output of India is currently processed as against 80% in some developed countries leaving a large potential to be tapped in this sector. India has a major agribusiness sector, which has achieved remarkable successes over the last three and a half decades. The Indian government has formulated Vision 2015, to triple the size of the food processing industry. In India, only 6% of total agro output of is currently processed as against 80% in some developed countries leaving a large potential to be tapped in this sector. At a time when a debate is raging on whether non-chemical farming (organic) can produce enough food to feed the world, compared to chemical farming, experts point to the fact that non– chemical method of practices definitely bring down the input costs required for cultivation (though some say they are labour intensive). Continuous and unbalanced use of chemical fertilizers6 is leading to decrease in nutrient uptake efficiency of plants resulting in stagnation of decrease in crop yield. At the same time, these fertilizers are costlier and also pollute the 21 22 environment through the process of de-nitrification, volatilization and ground water through leaching. Hence, efforts are to be made to tap new source of nutrients, which will be economical and may cerate a pollution free environment. Therefore, more attention is being paid towards the use of bio fertilizers in crop production. Cultivating is futile without processing and value addition, especially when our farmers are struggling to find ways to increase their income from farms. Local value added agricultural food production is an important strategy to sustain many small, marginal and agricultural laborers. What farmers need at the moment is a low budget technology that is efficient and proven. With more than 80 per cent of our farmers having small holding (3-4 acres), the need for such technology is imperative. Along with this a critical challenge is to ensure that the expanding use of good agricultural practices (GAP) should be taken into account the interest of small-scale producers both for the safety, economy and sustainability of domestic production and livelihoods security. Unfortunately, India is a country with a big rural market left untapped since many years. As rural people are unwilling to take risks hence a market has to be adopted in a totally different approach in locating and identifying the target market and relevant market segment for their products. And recent trends indicate that the rural markets are coming up in a big way. Effective communication can be used as a tool to reach them. The M.P. State Government has introduced organic policy to promote farmers towards organic farming and processing of products, wanting to give a lift to environment and soil health. But, all the policy remains ineffective due to lack of proper support system and coordination between state run departments, agriculture universities and farmers. Moreover, lack of desire marketing net and infrastructure in which organic products could get desired value is another issue to be addressed. Since August 2010, when the State Government introduced its Organic Policy7 2010 not even a single step towards shaping marketing system for organic farm products could be taken. Again in 2011, the Krishi Cabinet discussed organic farming at length in presence of experts at JNAU. They also gave recommendations on making policy effective but dependency on chemical fertilizers continues in state. In present trend, marketing channel has become a lifeline. Secondly, the facility of storage and distribution system plays key role in providing real benefits to growers. Other factors that affect progress of organic policy include soil health and organic certification of crops and low literacy amongst farmers. 22 23 The organic farming has become a costlier affair for farmers who are already using chemical fertilizers. As yield rate is much lower than farming with inorganic inputs, the cost of labour and application of organic insecticides, pesticides, fungicides turns the organic farm produces much costlier in comparison to present chemical based farming. Another challenge before organic farmers is to maintain the quality of produce when chemical based farm inputs are being openly marketed and sold to the farmers. The mechanization in farming has changed the whole scene in villages as they lack natural manure required to fulfill nutrient requirement of soil. There are about 300 clear sunny days in most parts of the country. Solar 3 energy applications can be an integral part of our daily lives touching every one of us in the future thereby helping us on reducing dependence on fossil fuels and other environmental benefits especially in agricultural applications of Solar Energy. Solar energy can supply and/or supplement many farm energy requirements. It has immense benefit for boiling and crop drying with simple, safe and least expensive use of solar equipments. The future of solar in India will explode to a level none of us can imagine if planned with the participatory efforts of all the stakeholders working in the grass root level specially the rural areas where frequent and long power cuts is a daily feature. Specialized training materials for our rural youths can be taken up from existing courses from the private sectors to meet the requirement of skilled manpower for initial setup of the field installations and an after-sales service net-work for the local area according the needs of agricultural/value additional requirements for the willing entrepreneurs later after the project takes a pace. Our project initiatives happened by chance during a monitoring work and it was then deemed to have a baseline survey of Dehrikalan village of Phanda block to understand the availability of natural resources, employment opportunities and other means of livelihood with the aim of improving the general living condition and the standard of life of the people. The study was also meant to understand the people of the village, their lifestyle and their level of acceptance to change, for the betterment of the village and the people of the village in general. Valuable experience gained during the monitoring process has helped us to find the major lacunae in the process moreover the programme emphasized on creating awareness through IEC strategies that needed for the delivery of the concept to the lower rung for the fulfillment of the objectives, Human resource development, and capacity development activities. 23 24 The land of the village is very fertile where wheat, gram, maize and soyabean are cultivated. As for irrigation the farmers are totally dependant on the rainfall, the returns from the fields is less than what is expected. A discussion with the people revealed that they are ready to learn and adopt activities that will give them an additional income besides their regular earnings from the crops. It was observed that at the moment the need was of a low budget technology that is efficient and proven. The choice of the value added products would give them an easy market for the products within their local market and neighborhood. After the baseline details it was deemed appropriate to take up the cultivation of Curcuma longa and Maranta arundinacea and its semi processing5 through demonstration. The application of solar energy for the same and entrepreneurship activity will help us for developing a rural employment opportunity. Materials and methods We have identified 75-85 SC families in the village to form cluster of 10 families in the village. The selection is based on motivation, desire to participate and willingness to lend their land for a long period with sustainability for promoting alternative additional livelihood means. Realizing the importance of post harvest processing in the areas it is embarked on establishing rural agro-processing centre to promote processing also, that is proposed to be designed to fully managed by clusters /women groups/youth groups or even family as groups for initial period under our guidance and with some small condition for the sustainability of the infrastructure so established. The center is proposed with need-based post harvest processing equipment that addresses the needs of the selected proposed medicinal plants in the village. Processing facilities is proposed to be established in production and growing areas that can render enhanced availability of raw materials at reduced costs and at the same time increase employment to the target partners. Beneficiary lending their land can be developed as demonstration plot (DP). A layout plan of the demonstration plot is designed and implemented. Various scientific methods using bio-fertilizers2 and bio-pesticides are adopted in the cultivation part. Later on harvesting, semi-processing of the harvest will be demonstrated during training schedules. 24 25 Results and Discussion Turmeric usage dates back from 3000 B.C. in India. From a significant part in daily cuisine to treating diseases like cancer, turmeric is beneficial to mankind. It is impossible to think of Indian food without turmeric. India is the world's largest producer of turmeric, i.e. nearly 90% of the world's total production. The productions of Turmeric in major states of India are as follows: Tamilnadu: 18%, Orissa: 7%, West Bengal: 4%, Karnataka: 4%, Gujarat: 2%, Maharashtra: 2%. With Major Trading Centers in India as Nizamabad, Dugirala (Andhra Pradesh), Sangli (Maharashtra), Coimbatore (Tamilnadu), Salem, Erode, Dharma Uri.Government’s support in the form of financial help /trainings/promotions /exhibitions has yet to reach farmers of all type at the grass roots. With that spirit, it is a small effort to bring the cultivation of haldi and arrowroot with non chemical techniques in Bhopal on a very small scale on pilot basis is being carried out with the beneficiary partners. Maranta arundinacea (arrow root) is a perennial, which grows for 6-12 months before harvest. It is used as an article of diet in the form of biscuits, puddings, jellies, cakes, hot sauces, etc., It is an easily digestible food for children and people with dietary restrictions. Used in diets requiring bland, low-salt, and lowprotein foods On the basis of the information collected, focus group discussions, semistructured interviews revealed that no new agricultural practices /interventions have been adopted by the villagers as such no source of additional income is generated for a decent living with capacities of giving higher educational to their girl children (which they very much long to do), hence we deemed it appropriate to take up the cultivation of Curcuma longa (Haldi) and Maranta arundinacea (Arrowroot) and its semi processing methods by establishing small units to be managed by the groups and plans of its sustainability. During the focus group discussions approximately 18-20 marginal farmers along with agricultural laborers have showed the inclination towards the use of solar equipments for agricultural application specially for dying of their produce. As we have targeted for a long-term sustenance of both the non-chemical farming methods through demonstrations and entrepreneurship activity for the rural woman with commitments will be taken care off. Both the plants are of great medicinal value and will prove to be a boon to the growers too. Maranta arundinacea (Arrowroot) also known as Tavaksira is used externally as well as internally. The powder of rhizomes with honey is applied 25 26 on the mucous membrane of the oral cavity, in stomatitis. It also promotes the healing of stomach ulcers. Internally it is extremely beneficial in diarrhea, dysentery and colitis as it is astringent. The rhizome powder cooked in milk is given along with sugar, in irritable bowel syndrome and ulcerative colitis to alleviate the irritation and facilitate the healing of ulcers. C. Longa (haldi) is widely used in Indian foods. Similar activities are practiced by various national laboratories of the country, ayurveda institutes, NGO's etc. Therefore the techno viability aspect of the project is very much assured. And since the project aims the cultivation of Curcuma longa (Haldi) and Maranta arundinacea (Arrowroot) and its semi processing through awareness and demonstration a need to explore assured buy back arrangement will be highly beneficial to the rural beneficiary partners. The processing of both the plant products has a great market potential, the usage of solar equipments will add to its value and a new learning for the beneficiary partners and a remunerative work. Cultivation of Maranta arundinacea (Arrowroot) is in a declining stage and has high medicinal value and the bye product in the arrowroot powder form has high market value, the sale of tubers, as seeds to other potential farmers of their area will also add to their income. On a pilot scale a self-sustaining (more of a very small cottage industry like) activity with assured buy back system is anticipated. Further, these types of project activities will promote the conservation of biodiversity too and revive cultivation of Maranta arundinacea (Arrowroot) too in the State Acknowlegements We highly acknowledge the kind gesture of Science and Technology Programme for Socio-Economic Development, Ministry of Science and Technology, Technology Bhawan, New Delhi to fund our dream of year 2000 to bring to grass root on a pilot basis the benefits of non-chemical farming techniques to beneficiary partners of two very important plants of medicinal value.Our deep gratitude to the valuable advice from Dr. Sivasubramaniam Edison, Member, BoT, International Potato Centre, Lima, Peru and Former Director, Central Tuber Crops Research Institution ,Trivandrum, Mr. Rajan Kuttapan , Administrator, Institute of Social Sciences,8 Nelson Mandela Road, New Delhi for his suggestions extended for the cause of beneficiary partners. Dr.U. Prakasham, IFS, Additional Director, SFRI for sponsoring seeds of medicinal value Thanks for timely support during the project start off, inclusion and deletions of necessary shortcomings of Mr. D. Manohar, Scientist NIC, Coimbatore and Mr. Antony.N.J., New Delhi. 26 27 References Anandaraj, M., Devasahayam, S., Zachariah, T.J., Eapen, S.J., Sasikumar, B., and Thankamani, C.K., 2001, Turmeric (Extension Pamphlet). Rema, J., and Madan, M.S., Editors. Indian Institute of Spices Research, Calicut, Kerala. API-Ayurvedic Pharmacopoeia of India 1989. New Delhi: Government of India-Ministry of Health and Family Welfare-Department of Health. 45-46. Chaudhary, D.R., Kisan world 2004, Bio- fertilizers for Improving crop Productivity, Vol. 31 No.10. Chandna, H., Sun rises on Solar Products, 2010, Hindustan Times. Iyengar, I., 2010, Jhabua village to banish darkness with solar lanterns, Hindustan Times. Kamble, K.J., Soni, S.B. Karnataka, and Agri, J., 2009, A study of improving turmeric processing . Sci22(1)137-139). Rajshree, V., Balakrishanmoorth, and Prabhuram, R., Kisan world 2006, Good Agricultural Practices, Vol.33 No-5. Sharma, A., Dwivedi, N., and Khanuja, S.P.S., 2000, Sourcing information on R&D and trade of medicinal and aromatic plants through web data mining: Some utility sites. Journal of Medicinal and Aromatic Plant Sciences. 24 (1):82103. The Hindu, 2009, Crafts Bazaar to focus on sustainable livelihood. The Hitavada, 2012, Lack of co-ordination hampering organic farming. 27 28 Journal of Today’s Biological Sciences: Research & Review (JTBSRR) ISSN 2320-1444 (Online) JTBSRR Vol.1, Issue 1, page 28-52, December 30, 2012 Available on: www.jtbsrr.in Studies on Interaction of Argonaute Protein and Micro RNA of Chlamydomonas reinhardtii P.A. Dang Pritha Bhattacharya(Sasmal) Netaji Mahavidyalaya, Arambagh,Hooghly, Email-pritha.sasmal@gmail.com Abstract RNA interference(RNAi) is an ancient mechanism of gene suppression. Usually RNA interference is defined as a homology dependent gene silencing mechanism that involves double stranded RNA directed against a target gene or its promoter region. Chlamydomonas reinhardtii is a unicellular green alga.Chlamydomonas contains a set of endogenous microRNAs (miRNAs) that down-regulate their target gene expression through mRNA cleavage. During RNA silencing mechanism these miRNA can interact with Argonaute protein.With the help of CHIMERA software it has been found that miRNAs contain some conserved nucleotide sequences through which they interact with Argonaute proteins. If we want to make a new antisense miRNA these conserved sequences must be targeted for successful interaction with the target miRNA. Key Words: RNAi, Antisence miRNA, Argonaute protein, NMR spectroscopy, Protein Data Bank (PDB), MC-FOLD MC-SYM, HEX, UCSF CHIMERA Introduction RNA interference is an ancient mechanism of gene suppression. Usually RNA interference is defined as a homology dependent gene silencing mechanism that involves double stranded RNA directed against a target gene or its promoter region. RNA interference is abbreviated as RNAi. RNAi is but one aspect of a larger web of sequence-specific, cellular responses to RNA known collectively as RNA Silencing. 28 29 RNAi was first discovered in Petunia hybrida at around 1990. After that many works has been done on RNAi & Finally in 2006 Andrew Z.Fire & Craig C.Mello received the Nobel Prize for their discovery that ds RNA triggers suppression of gene activity in a homology dependent manner. It has been found that All RNA silencing pathways are triggered by 21-27 nt long ‘small RNAs’ –a term that encompasses small interfering RNAs (si RNA), repeat –associated small interfering RNA (rasi RNAs),micro RNAs (mi RNAs) etc. Materials and Methods Throughout the entire duration of work many computational approaches have been used to obtain the ultimate results. The key algorithms that have been used, are briefly explained in the 1st part of the method section which is followed by a flow chart of the work flow which was followed. Resources A. miRBASE : The microRNA Database The miRBase database is a searchable database of published miRNA sequences and annotation. Each entry in the miRBase Sequence database represents a predicted hairpin portion of a miRNA transcript (termed mir in the database), with information on the location and sequence of the mature miRNA sequence (termed miR).Both hairpin and mature sequences are available for searching and browsing, and entries can also be retrieved by name, keyword, references and annotation. All sequence and annotation data are also available for download. The miRBase Registry provides miRNA gene hunters with unique names for novel miRNA genes prior to publication of results. Visit the help pages for more information about the naming service. The miRBase Targets database and pipeline has been rebranded as microCosm, and is now hosted at the EBI. The microCosm resource continues to be maintained by the Enright group. miRBase currently links miRNAs to targets predicted by microCosm,TargetScan and Pictar, and aims to provide a more extensive target prediction aggregation service in the future. B. PDB : Protein Data Bank The Protein Data Bank (PDB) is a repository for the 3-D structural data of large biological molecules, such as proteins and nucleic acids. The data, typically obtained by X-ray crystallography or NMR spectroscopy and submitted by biologists and biochemists from around the world, are freely accessible on the 29 30 Internet via the websites of its member organisations (PDBe,PDBj, and RCSB). The PDB is overseen by an organization called the Worldwide Protein Data Bank, wwPDB. The PDB is a key resource in areas of structural biology, such as structural genomics. Most major scientific journals, and some funding agencies, such as the NIH in the USA, now require scientists to submit their structure data to the PDB. If the contents of the PDB are thought of as primary data, then there are hundreds of derived (i.e., secondary) databases that categorize the data differently. For example, both SCOP and CATH categorize structures according to type of structure and assumed evolutionary relations; GO categorize structures based on genes. C . MC-FOLD MC-SYM The MC-Fold | MC-Sym pipeline is a web-hosted service for RNA secondary and tertiary structure prediction. The pipeline means that the input sequence to MC-Fold outputs secondary structures that are direct input to MC-Sym, which outputs tertiary structures.The vertical bar '|' is the symbol indicating pipeline processing in Unix, which was invented by Malcolm D. McIlroy. MC-Fold predicts secondary structures from sequence (black arrow). Compared to classical secondary structures that include the AU, CG, and Wobble GU base pairs that form the stems of the structure, MC-Fold's secondary structures include the other base pairing patterns as well. These are often called noncanonical base pairs. D. HEX Hex is an interactive molecular graphics program for calculating and displaying feasible docking modes of pairs of protein and DNA molecules. Hex can also calculate protein-ligand docking, assuming the ligand is rigid, and it can superpose pairs of molecules using only knowledge of their 3D shapes. Hex has been available for about 12 years now, but as far as known, it is still the only docking and super postion program to use spherical polar Fourier (SPF) correlations to accelerate the calculations, and its still one of the few docking programs which has built-in graphics to view the results. The graphical nature of Hex came about largely to visualise the results of such docking calculations in a natural and seamless way, without having to export unmanageably many coordinate files to one of the many existing molecular graphics programs. For this reason, the graphical capabilities in Hex are generally relatively primitive compared to professional molecular graphics packages, but you're aiming to use Hex to do docking, not to make publication-quality images. 30 31 E. UCSF Chimera : An Extensible Molecular Modeling System UCSF Chimera is a highly extensible program for interactive visualization and analysis of molecular structures and related data, including density maps, supra molecular assemblies, sequence alignments, docking results, trajectories, and conformational ensembles. High-quality images and animations can be generated. Chimera includes complete documentation and several tutorials, and can be downloaded free of charge for academic, government, non-profit, and personal use. Chimera is developed the Resource for HYPERLINK "http://www.rbvi.ucsf.edu/"BiocomputingHYPERLINK "http://www.rbvi.ucsf.edu/", Visualization, and Informatics and funded by the NIH National Center for Research Resources. Method ANALYSIS WORKFLOW COLLECTION OF SEQUENCES OF miRNAs FROM miRBASE GENERATION OF THE miRNA 2D STRUCTURES DERIVATION OF THE 3D STRUCTURES OF miRNAs GENERATION OF HOMOLOGY MODEL FOR ARGONAUTE PROTEIN STIMULATION OF INTERACTION THROUGH miRNA-AGO COMPLEX USING HEX STIMULATION OF THE POINT OF INTERACTION OF miRNA-AGO COMPLEX 31 32 Fig.1. Docking structure of different miRNA & argonaute protein of Chlamydomonas reinhardtii Argonaute 1+ miRNA 20. Argonaute 1+ miRNA 21 32 33 Argonaute 1+miRNA 22 Argonaute 1+miRNA 23. Argonaute 1+miRNA 24. 33 34 Table 1. Points of interaction between miRNAS & Argonaute protein of Chlamydomonas reinhardtii Sl. No. Sequence Argonaute Name of interacting amino acid LYS GLY SER Protein MiRNA Position of those amino acid 852 A 11.A 2HO’ 854 A 9.A HO2’ 792 A 11.A C1’ 1. AGO+MiRNA 1 2. AGO+MiRNA 2 LEU 255 #0(Adenine) 3. AGO+MiRNA 3 THR PRO 942 941 #0(Guanine) G 11.A O2’ 4. AGO+MiRNA 5 ASP SER ASP LYS ALA PRO VAL 473 604 472 435 436 586 605 A 10.A C 12.A 2OH’ #0(Guanine) ,, ,, C 12.A HO2’ A 10.A C4’C5’ 1.527 Angstrom 5. AGO+MiRNA 6 GLY PRO GLY GLY SER LEU TYR 278 69 270 68 279 280 275 #0(Cytosine) #0(Guanine) G12.A 2HO’ #0(Guanine) C 11.A HO2’ G 12.A HO2’ C 11.A 2HO’ 6. AGO+MiRNA 7 GLY SER MET PRO LYS ASN 706 705 332 237 240 623 #0(Uracil) ,, C 22.A 2HO’ #0(Adenine) U 1.A A 3.A HO2’ 34 Remarks 35 7. AGO+MiRNA 8 ASP 563 #0(Uracil) LYS 531 #0(Adenine) TYR 560 #0(Uracil) 8. AGO+MiRNA 9 HIS LEU ARG GLU PRO PRO GLN 818 220 246 247 817 817 816 U 20.A 2HO’ G 21.A HO2’ G 21.A G 21.A U 2.A O2’ U 2.A 2HO’ U 2.A HO2’ 9. AGO+MiRNA 10 PRO 167 #0(Adenine) ALA MET ASP SER GLU PRO 165 332 331 239 238 237 ,, ,, ,, A 9.A O4’ C 8.A U 7.A HO2’ ARG 246 A 21.A GLU 247 ARG PRO GLN 246 817 816 A 21.A C3’03’ 1.431 Angstrom C 20.A G 2.A 2HO’ G 3.A 2HO’ ASP 232 #0(Adenine) ASP SER ALA HIS PRO 232 234 224 818 817 #0(Cytosine) C 21.A #0(Adenine) A 1.A O2’ ,, 10. 11. AGO+MiRNA 11 AGO+MiRNA 12 35 Very very close Interacti on. 36 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. AGO+MiRNA 13 AGO+MiRNA 14 AGO+MiRNA 16 AGO+MiRNA 17 AGO+MiRNA 18 VAL 605 A 9.A SER ASP ASP HIS GLU MET 604 472 473 552 553 554 SER 604 G 10.A #0(Uracil) ,, A 9.A HO2’ A 9.A C3’ G 10.A C4’C5’ 1.510 Angstrom U 11.A ARG 681 C 20.A HO2’ LYS PRO PRO 710 586 586 LEU 585 SER 707 G 19.A HO2’ G 19.A HO2’ C 20.A C3’C4’ 1.601 Angstrom C 20.A C3’03’ 1.432 Angstrom U 1.A HO2’ ALA 791 C 10.A GLY 854 C 8.A ALA 168 #0(Cytosine) ALA VAL 171 159 SER 239 ,, C 9.A C1’-04’ 1.412 Angstrom G 8.A HO2’ ASP 594 C 4.A ASN 667 G 3.A 36 37 17. 18. 19. 20. AGO+MiRNA 20 AGO+MiRNA 21 AGO+MiRNA 22 AGO+MiRNA 23 ASP ASN ASP VAL 594 667 473 605 G 2.A C4’ U 1.A #0(Guanine) #0(Cytosine) CYS 641 G 20.A O2’ CYS CYS LEU MET 648 648 644 332 U 1.A HO2’ U 2.A U 1.A 2HO’ #0(Guanine) SER 705 #0(Uracil) GLY VAL VAL SER GLU PRO CYS LEU MET 706 704 704 239 238 237 648 644 332 ,, U 1.A N1 U1.A O4’ U 1.A ,, ,, G 20.A 2HO’ C 21.A C3’ #0(Adenine) ILE 551 #0(Adenine) HIS HIS 593 593 GLY ARG ILE SER 458 441 442 665 A 13.A 2HO’ A 13.A 02’C2’ 1.41 Angstrom #0(Adenine) ,, ,, A 13.A 2HO’ GLY 706 U 11.A MET MET 332 332 U 11.A C4’ A 10.A C1’- 37 38 21. 22. 23. 24. 25. AGO+MiRNA 24 AGO+MiRNA 25 AGO+MiRNA 27 AGO+MiRNA 28 AGO+MiRNA ALA 687 N9 1.441 Angstrom A 10.A C3’ PRO 167 #0(Guanine) PHE SER ALA LEU PRO 158 705 171 164 237 #0(Uracil) C 13.A #0(Uracil) #0(Guanine) #0(Cytosine) ASP 293 A 123.A ILE THR GLY 292 853 854 ARG LYS LYS 855 297 299 A 13.A A 12.A G 11.A C3’03’ 1.427 Angstrom G 11.A C4’ G 11.A O4’ #0(Guanine) GLY 926 G 9.A C3’ SER HIS PRO THR ASN 925 940 941 807 754 G 10.A C 11.A G 10.A #0(Guanine) ,, TYR 592 C 1.A GLN ARG GLY SER GLU ASP 329 328 327 604 553 472 ,, #0(Cytosine) #0(Guanine) ,, G 21.A HO2’ G 21.A LYS 258 Guanine 38 39 29 26. 27. 28. 29. AGO+MiRNA 30 AGO+MiRNA 31 AGO+MiRNA 32 AGO+MiRNA GLY HIS TYR SER PRO GLN GLY LEU TYR ARG 257 230 231 349 348 450 314 318 319 330 ,, ,, ,, Uracil ,, U 10.A Uracil G 9.A ,, U 8.A 02’ GLY 439 Cytosine VAL 440 VAL ARG HIS GLU GLY 440 441 552 553 458 C 12.A c1’c2’1.527 angstrom uracil uracil ,, ,, Cytosine PHE 469 C 12.A C4’ ASP ILE ASP VAL 472 551 472 605 G 11.A 2HO’ A 10.A O2’ G 11.A C4’ C 9.A 2OH’ GLY 278 G 9.A SER LEU PRO PRO GLU TRP PHE 279 280 281 281 303 497 872 ,, ,, ,, A 10.A ,, U 11.A U 11.A C3’ TRP 497 Adenine 39 40 33 30. 31. 32. AGO+MiRN A 34 AGO+MiRN A 35 AGO+MiRN A 36 GLY PHE 278 402 GLU PHE ARG 303 872 856 C 21.A C 21.A C3’03’ 1.431 Angstrom C 21.A HO2’ U 3.A G 4.A 2HO’ ALA 815 C 2.A 2HO’ ALA TYR ASP ASP VAL SER 815 231 232 232 233 234 C 2.A C1’ U 3.A 2HO’ Uracil Adenine ,, A 20.A 2HO’ ASP 473 Guanine GLN ASN 549 649 GLU 548 G 12.A HO2’ Guanine GLU 247 Uracil ALA ALA 224 178 VAL VAL 221 221 LEU TYR ASP PRO PRO 966 967 968 817 817 U 21.A U 21.A HO2’ U 21.A O2’ U 21.A 2HO’ C 20.A O2’ ,, C 20.A C1’ G 19.A O2’ G 19.A 40 ,, 41 33. 34. 35. 36. 37. AGO+MiRN A 37 Ago+MiRNA 38. AGO+MiRN A 39 AGO+MiRN A 40 AGO+MiRN GLN PRO PRO 816 96 96 Guanine G 2.A U 1.A ASP 472 A 8.A HO2’ ASP ASP GLY GLN ARG 473 473 606 329 33O C 9.A C4’ A 10.A ,, Adenine ,, ALA 171 ILE LEU LEU 700 701 701 VAL SER GLU 704 705 238 C 21.A 2HO’ C 21.A C2’ C 21.A C3’ C 21.A C3’03’ 1.432 Angstrom C 21.A U 20.A Uracil ASP 331 A 11.A SER LEU GLY SER SER 683 686 706 705 705 ,, C 12.A A 11.A G 10.A Cytosine ASN 649 G 3.A 2HO’ LEU 686 ILE GLY LEU MET 645 652 686 332 U 20.A 2HO’ ,, C 4.A 2HO’ C 2.A 2HO’ C 2.A ARG 330 G 12.A 41 42 A 41 38. 39. 40. AGO+MiRN A 42 AGO+MiRN A 43 AGO+MiRN A 44 SER SER VAL 550 550 605 ILE ASP ASN GLY MET 645 472 649 652 653 MET 653 CYS 1058 MET MET VAL GLY GLY ARG GLN GLU 1055 1055 1054 854 854 855 904 892 U 20.A 2HO’ G 4.A HO2’ G 4.A G 4.A C3’ Guanine U 19.A ,, G 21.A O3’ U 20.A O2’ ARG 856 U 9.A 2HO’ GLY GLU PHE 30 858 872 Guanine Uracil G 10.A CYS 1058 Uracil ALA 989 U 2HO’ PHE LYS 900 852 A 21.A U 19.A HO2’ 42 G 12.A C3’ A 13.A A 13.A HO2’ ,, Guanine G 15.A ,, G 15.A HO2’ C 16.A C4’04’ 1.453 Angstrom 20.A 43 41. 42. 43. 44. 45. AGO+MiRN A 45 AGO+MiRN A 46 AGO+MiRN A 47 AGO+MiRN A 48 AGO+MiRN A 49 GLY 58 Uracil PRO PRO GLY GLY GLY 60 59 32 29 31 Guanine ,, U 9.A O2’ U 7.A U 8.A VAL 440 Adenine GLY PHE 439 469 PHE THR GLU ARG 469 600 598 597 Uracil G 20.A 2HO’ U 1.A HO2’ A 2.A HO2’ A 3.A A 3.A HO2’ GLY 439 U 11.A VAL GLU ASP LYS 440 598 594 599 THR 600 A 12.A U 17.A A 18.A C 16.A HO2’ A 15.A HO2’ SER 241 ARG 242 ALA 976 THR GLY 162 709 LEU 701 PHE 469 43 U 14.A 2HO’ U 14.A HO2’ G 13.A 2HO’ G 13.A O4’ C 11.A 2HO’ A 15.A O2’ G HO2’ 21.A 44 46. 47. 48. 49. 50. 51. AGO+Mi RNA 50 AGO+MiRN A 51 AGO+MiRN A 52 AGO+MiRN A 53 AGO+MiRN A 54 AGO+MiRN A 55 PRO ARG GLN 424 423 549 G 21.A C4’ ,, G 21.A TYR 231 ASN ARG ASN PHE 245 246 245 158 C 17.A HO2’ Uracil ,, Cytosine C 19.A HO2’ GLN 329 Uracil SER ILE VAL SER 550 645 605 654 ,, Cytosine C 8.A O4’ G 6.A 2HO’ ASN 764 Cytosine TYR 967 ASN 764 U 19.A HO2’ Uracil SER 683 ASP CYS SER 331 648 705 G 12.A HO2’ G 12.A Guanine Cytosine GLU 758 Guanine GLU THR THR PRO 758 755 942 941 Adenine ,, A 9.A A 9.A HO2’ THR 853 C 12.A 44 45 52. 53. 54. 55. AGO+MiRN A 56 AGO+MiRN A 57 AGO+MiRN A 58 AGO+MiRN A 59 ILE ILE ALA 292 292 791 LYS 297 ,, U 13.A U 13.A HO2’ G 11.A C4’ CYS 1058 Guanine ARG ARG THR PHE GLU 856 855 853 900 892 Cytosine ,, C 10.A C1’ Cytosine ,, CYS 1058 GLU GLY 892 854 ASP 881 C 9.A HO2’O2’ O.960 Angstrom C 9.A U7.A C4’C5’ 1.528 Angstrom C 8.A C3’ PRO 70 LEU 228 SER THR LYS 260 259 258 G 19.A 2HO’ C 20.A 2HO’ ,, Cytosine Adenine VAL 605 G 18.A ARG GLN ASP 330 329 473 ASP ASP 473 472 G 19.A ,, G 19.A HO2’ A 20.A C3’ A 20.A HO2’ 45 46 56. 57. 58. 59. 60. 61. 62. AGO+MiRN A 60 AGO+MiRN A 61 AGO+MiRN A 62 AGO+MiRN A 63 AGO+MiRN A 64 AGO+MiRN A 65 AGO+MiRN A 66 GLY 706 C 11.A C4’ MET 332 Cytosine MET 653 G 7.A HO2’ ASN SER ASN ASP ASP 649 604 474 473 473 G 7.A C4’ Adenine U 1.A ,, G 2.A PRO 817 U 9.A GLN ALA PRO 816 815 96 ,, Adenine C 6.A 2HO’ ALA 208 U 10.A LYS GLY GLU 808 204 771 G 11.A C4’ Uracil G 13.A 2HO’ LYS 905 LYS CYS 1052 1058 C 19.A C3’O3’ 1.432 Angstrom G 18.A C 19.A LYS 905 LYS CYS 1052 1058 C 19.A C3’O3’ 1.432 Angstrom G 18.A C 19.A ARG 367 G 11.A 46 47 63. 64. 65. 66. 67. AGO+MiRN A 67 AGO+MiRN A 68 AGO+MiRN A 69 AGO+MiRN A 70 AGO+MiRN A 71 PHE GLN ARG 364 363 850 A 10.A C3’ A 10.A C4’ U 12.A C4’ SER 550 Cytosine VAL ASP ASP PHE LYS 605 473 472 469 599 C 13.A C2’ A 12.A U 11.A O4’ Adenine U 14.A HO2’ ASN 970 ALA ASN PRO ALA 224 245 817 815 G 21.A 2HO’ G 21.A C3’ Guanine G 20.A O2’ A 1.A O2’ GLY 854 ARG TYR 855 1057 CYS 1058 GLY 652 ASN VAL VAL 649 605 605 ASP ILE 472 468 SER 705 C 8.A 2HO’ GLY SER 706 683 Guanine Adenine 47 A 19.A HO2’ G 20.A C 21.A 2HO’ ,, C 14.A 2HO’ C 14.A C3’ C 13.A G 12.A 2HO’ G 11.A A 10.A HO2’ 48 68. 69. 70. 71. 72. 73. AGO+MiRN A 72 AGO+MiRN A 73 AGO+MiRN A 74 AGO+MiRN A 75 AGO+MiRN A 76 AGO+MiRN A 77 ASP 331 A HO2’ ARG 910 ARG LYS 906 905 G 22.A 2HO’ Guanine Adenine A 10.A HO2’ SER 683 Uracil SER GLY GLU SER 707 706 238 239 ,, U 1.A G 20.A A 1.A LYS LEU CYS 240 701 648 THR GLY 651 652 A 1.A O4’ Adenine G 19.A 2HO’ U 4.A HO2’ U 4.A 2HO’ ASP 472 G 1.A ASP MET 473 653 ,, VAL 605 C 20.A 2HO’ Guanine ASP 473 A 9.A C1’ ASP VAL 472 605 Adenine A 8.A C4’ MET 332 THR 682 A HO2’ G HO2’ 48 10.A 17.A 16.A 49 74. 75. 76. 77. 78. 79. 80. AGO+MiRN A 78 AGO+MiRN A 80 AGO+MiRN A 81 AGO+MiRN A 82 AGO+MiRN A 83 AGO+MiRN A 84 AGO+MiRN A 85 MET 332 THR 682 ALA 815 A 2.A O2’ HIS ASP VAL 230 232 233 U 3.A 2HO’ Adenine A 20.A 2HO’ SER 705 Cytosine HIS 679 C 10.A O4’ GLN 450 Guanine ASP 449 HIS GLN 366 363 G 13.A HO2’ U 11.A A 9.A THR 853 U 1.A 2HO’ GLY 854 Adenine GLY 854 A 12.A ALA GLU LYS ALA 791 892 905 791 C 11.A G 10.A C4’ Guanine Adenine HIS 783 A HO2’ 49 A HO2’ G HO2’ 17.A 16.A 10.A 50 Discussion From the above result it has been found that in Argonaute protein – Ser 239,Val 605,Glu 238, Asp 472,Gln 549,Asn 649,Met 332,Ser 705,Lys 258,ILE 645,PRO 941,Phe 469,amino acid residues are very common as interacting points. So site specific mutagenesis among these amino acids can be done to regulate the binding of miRNA with Argonaute proteins & thus can hamper the RNAi mechinary. Similarly it has also been observed that miRNAs also contain some conserved nucleotide sequences through which they interact with Argonaute proteins.So if we want to make a new antisense miRNA these conserved sequences must be targeted for successful interaction with the target miRNA. Future prospects I hope that these effort will be beneficial for future researchers in the computational field as well as in the wet lab. Acknowledgement I would like to extend my thanks to professor Abhijit Datta of Presidency University,Kolkata,for his help & advice in the formulation & application of the computer simulation that was used here. References Websites http://www.biomedcentral.com/content/pdf/gb-2008-9-2-210.pdf http://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/pubmed?term=Brassica%20RNAi http://www.biomedcentral.com/content/pdf/gb-2008-9-2-210.pdf www.loria.fr/~ritchied/hex/ http://www.pdb.org/pdb/home/home.do http://dinamelt.bioinfo.rpi.edu/quickfold.php. mfold.rna.albany.edu/?q=DINAMelt/Quickfold http://www.major.iric.ca/MC-pipeline/ http://www.cgl.ucsf.edu/chimera/ http://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/pubmed/ http://www.jbc.org/content/early/2011/05/16/jbc.M111.240259.long http://pcp.oxfordjournals.org/content/early/2011/05/16/pcp.pcr063.long http://www.springerlink.com/content/481420138lt30244/ 50 51 Others Daneholt, Bertil. "Advanced Information: RNA interference". The Nobel Prize in Physiology or Medicine 2006. Retrieved 2007-01-25. Fire A, Xu S, Montgomery M, Kostas S, Driver S, Mello C (1998). "Potent and specific genetic interference by double-stranded RNA inCaenorhabditis elegans". Nature 391 (6669): 806–11. doi:10.1038/35888. PMID 9486653. Macrae I, Zhou K, Li F, Repic A, Brooks A, Cande W, Adams P, Doudna J (2006). "Structural basis for double-stranded RNA processing by dicer". Science 311 (5758): 195–8. doi:10.1126/science.1121638. PMID 16410517. Bagasra O, Prilliman KR (2004). "RNA interference: the molecular immune system". J. Mol. Histol. 35 (6): 545–53. doi:10.1007/s10735-004-21928. PMID 15614608. Bernstein E, Caudy A, Hammond S, Hannon G (2001). "Role for a bidentate ribonuclease in the initiation step of RNA interference". Nature409 (6818): 363– 6. doi:10.1038/35053110. PMID 11201747. Siomi, Haruhiko; Siomi, Mikiko C. (22 January 2009). "On the road to reading the RNA-interference code". Nature 457 (7228): 396– 404.doi:10.1038/nature07754. PMID 19158785. Zamore P, Tuschl T, Sharp P, Bartel D (2000). "RNAi: double-stranded RNA directs the ATP-dependent cleavage of mRNA at 21 to 23 nucleotide intervals". Cell 101 (1): 5–33. doi:10.1016/S0092-8674(00)80620-0. PMID 10778853. Vermeulen A, Behlen L, Reynolds A, Wolfson A, Marshall W, Karpilow J, Khvorova A (2005). Castanotto, Daniela; Rossi, John J. (22 January 2009). "The promises and pitfalls of RNA-interference-based therapeutics". Nature 457(7228):426– 433. doi:10.1038/nature07758. PMC 2702667. PMID 19158789. Qiu S, Adema C, Lane T (2005). "A computational study of off-target effects of RNA interference". Ahlquist P (2002). "RNA-dependent RNA polymerases, viruses, and RNA silencing". Science 296 (5571):12703.doi:10.1126/science.1069132. PMID 12016304. Parker G, Eckert D, Bass B (2006). Liu Q, Rand T, Kalidas S, Du F, Kim H, Smith D, Wang X (2003). "R2D2, a bridge between the initiation and effector steps of the 51 52 Drosophila RNAi pathway". Science 301 (5641): 5. doi:10.1126/science.1088710. PMID 14512631. 1921– Baulcombe,D.(2007). "Molecular biology. Amplified silencing". Science 315 (5809):199200. doi:10.1126/science.1138030.PMID 1721851 7. Pak J, Fire A (2007). "Distinct populations of primary and secondary effectors during RNAi in C. elegans". Science 315 (5809): 241– 4.doi:10.1126/science.1132839. PMID 17124291. Sijen T, Steiner F, Thijssen K, Plasterk R (2007). "Secondary siRNAs result from unprimed RNA synthesis and form a distinct class". Science315 (5809): 244– 7. doi:10.1126/science.1136699. PMID 17158288. Wang QL, Li ZH (2007). "The functions of microRNAs in plants". Front. Biosci. 12: 3975–82. PMID 17485351. Zhao Y, Srivastava D (2007). "A developmental view of microRNA function". Trends Biochem. Sci. 32 (4): 189– 97.doi:10.1016/j.tibs.2007.02.006. PMID 17350266. Gregory R, Chendrimada T, Shiekhattar R (2006). "MicroRNA biogenesis: isolation and characterization of the microprocessor complex".Methods Mol Biol 342: 33–47. doi:10.1385/1-59745-123-1:33. PMID 16957365. Pillai RS, Bhattacharyya SN, Filipowicz W (2007). "Repression of protein synthesis by miRNAs: how many mechanisms?". Trends Cell Biol17 (3): 118– 26. doi:10.1016/j.tcb.2006.12.007. PMID 17197185. 52 53 Journal of Today’s Biological Sciences: Research & Review (JTBSRR) ISSN 2320-1444 (Online) JTBSRR Vol.1, Issue 1, page 53-58, December 30, 2012 Available on: www.jtbsrr.in An investigation on ethno-veterinary medicinal plants of Siliguri Subdivision of Darjeeling District, West Bengal, India Tamal Mondal Department of Botany, Netaji Mahavidyalaya, Arambagh, Hooghly, West Bengal, India, Email: tamalmondal1@gmail.com Abstract This study and instigation was aimed to find out the ethno-medicinal plants of Siliguri Sub division of Darjeeling District, West Bengal, used to treat the various veterinary diseases. In the present study, 36 medicinal plants belonging to 28 families used as veterinary medicines have been documented. According to this study, documenting the medicinal plants and associated indigenous knowledge can be used for conservation and sustainable use of medicinal plants in the area and for effective treatment of various disease and disorders of domestic animals. Key words Ethno-veterinary medicine, medicinal plants, documentation, indigenous knowledge Introduction Plants are used for medicinal purposes by local peoples since ancient times. It is an established fact that plants serve a potent medicine for curing various diseases of local people as well as livestock’s. Various plant formulations are also used in folk medicine as well as our traditional medicines like allopathy, homoeopathy, ayurvadic, siddha and unani medicines. EVM (Ethno-Veterinary Medicine) is a system based on folk traditional skills, knowledge, and practices for curing various diseases and disorders and maintaining good health of our domestic animals (Mathias-Mundy and McCorkle, 1989; Tabuti et al., 2003; Kumari Rita et al., 2011; Kumari Reshmi et al., 2011; Bhardwaj, Ugala et al., 2011).Darjeeling 53 54 District, West Bengal ,India is famous for its biodiversity as well as for medicinal plants.Siliguri Subdivision belongs to Darjeeling District and a part of famous ‘tarai’ region the foot hills of Darjeeling Himalaya; well known area for its rich biodiversity.The study area,Siliguri Subdivision is situated at 26º43´N latitude and 88º25´E longitude within Darjeeling District of West Bengal,India.The Subdivision contains 22 gram panchayats(rural area) under four community development blocks; 1.Matigara,2.Naxalbari,3.Phansidewa,and 4.Kharibari, including SMC(Siliguri Municipal Corporation).The ethnic groups lives in this area are Santhals,Munda and Oraon tribes.In this Investigation as well as field survey a total 36 number of medicinal plants belonging to 28 families are found which are used successfully by the traditional healers of that area for treatment of various disease and disorders of domestic animals. Materials and Methods This investigation mainly based on botanical field trips in the blocks and rural areas of the Siliguri subdivision mainly inhabited by ethnic tribal communities such as Santhals, Oraon and Mundas. The plants used for their healthcare purpose were recorded through personal interview with the local traditional healers and also local aged peoples during these field works. a pre-prepared questioner was used for this purpose. At first step 36 plants belonging to 28 families were selected and collected from those areas. Next step is proper identification of the collected plant species. Collected specimens were preserved and worked out by following standard taxonomic methods and authentic literature (Prain.1903: Bennet 1987). The local older peoples as well as traditional healers were the primary informants who were interviewed during this field work and the data have been recorded along with their names, address and the medicinal uses are recorded from them. Results and Discussion The ethno-veterinary medicinal plants of Siliguri Subdivision,their scientific name,family in which they belongs,their local names along with their important portion as well as their medicinal properties are presented in table 1. Table 1. List of ethno-veterinary medicinal plants found in Siliguri subdivision Darjeeling, West Bengal Serial Scientific No. Name Acorus 1. calamus Local Name (In Bengali) Buch Family Plant parts used Areceae Leaf,roots 54 Veterinary Medicinal uses Stomachic,stimu lant,digestive problems 55 2. Adhatoda vasica Basak Acanthaceae 3. Aegle marmelos Bael Rutaceae 4. Aloe vera Ghritakumari Liliaceae 5. Alstonia scholaris Chatim Apocynaceae 6. Amaranthus oleraceus Bonnote Amaranthaceae 7. Amaranthus Lal sak tricolor Andrographis Kalmegh paniculata Amaranthaceae Artemisia vulgaris Azadirachta indica Bryophyllum calycinum Cajanus cajan Nagdamoni, Titapati Neem Asteraceae Leaves,roots Meliaceae Leaves,bark, Pathar kuchi Crassulaceae Leaves Aorhar Fabaceae Leaves,seeds 13. Calotropis procera Akando Asclepiadeceae Leaves 14. Cannabis sativa Vang Cannabinaceae Whole plant 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. Acanthaceae 55 Whole plants Cough and cold,bronchitis,s cabis Fruits Gastric problems, diarrhea and dysentery, respiratory disorder, Flashy leaves Cut and burn,skin diseases,diarrhe a Leaves and bark Jaundice, Diarrhea and dysentery Leaves Skin problems, cough and cold, eye problems, pimples Whole plants Blood purifier, anemia, Leaves, whole Liver problems, plants bile problems Ringworm,bliste r,pimples Skin problems, dental problems Urinary problems, piles Jaundice, bile problems, digestive disorder, Acidity,flatulanc e, Asthma, dental problems, Any type of pain,nausa and vomiting 56 15. Centrella asiatica 16. Whole plant Diarrhea and dysentery,fever, blood purifier, Chenopodium Bethua sak Album Citrus Kagoji labu aurantifolia Chenopodiaceae Whole plant Rutaceae Fruits,seeds Curcuma longa Datura metel Holud Zingiberaceae Rhizome extracts Dhuturo Solanaceae Leaf,root,seeds Worms, blood purifier, piles Digestive problems,collera ,worm Jaundice and wonds Muscle pain,worms,won ds Emblica officinalis Ficus carica Amlaki Euphorbiaceae Fruit,leaves Dumur Moraceae Leaves, fruits 22. Heliotropium indicum Hatisur Boranginaceae Leaves 23. Ipomoea hederacea Kalmi sak Convolvulaceae Leaves,total plants 24. Lantena camara Chotra Verbinaceae Leaves,flower 25. Luffa cylindrica Marsilea quardrifolia Dhudul Cucurbitaceae Fruit,leaves Susni sak Marsileaceae Leaves,total plants Mentha piperita Mimosa pudica Pudina Lamiaceae Whole plants Lajjabati Mimosaceae Leaves 17. 18. 19. 20. 21. 26. 27. 28. Thankuni Apiaceae 56 Indigestion,gastr ic problems Diabetes, gastric problems Insomnia, digestive problems Menstruation problems, digestive problems, constipation Antibiotic,antise ptic,skin problems Acidity, bile problem Cough and cold,bronchitis,e ye problems Indigetion,vomit ing,ear problems Asthma,nerve problems 57 29. Mirabilis jalapa Sondhamoni Nyctaginaceae 30. Moringa oleifera Ocimum sanctum Sojina Moringaceae Tulsi Lamiaceae 32. Paedenia foetida Ghandhamadan Rubiaceae 33. Solanum nigrum Kakmachi Solanaceae 34. Tagetes erecta Gada Asteraceae Leaves,Flowers 35. Vitex negundo Nisinda Verbenaceae Leaves 36. Zizyphus mauritiana Kul Rhamnaceae Fruits 31. Roots,Leaves,seeds Wounds,antiinflammatory activity Flower,fruit Piles,worm,coug h, Leaves,seeds,total Cough and plants cold,fever,skin problems,insect bite Leaves,total plants Diarrhea and decentry,gastric problems Fruits,seeds Fever, cough and cold, acidity Cut and wounds,burn,ins ect bite Muscle & Joint pain,antiinflama tory,antibiotic Acidity,thrust,bi le problems Conclusion Traditional healers collect their plant remedy from local places and conserve their knowledge among selected peoples, if their knowledge will spread through out the world it is a great achievement for mankind to make low cost, effective potential, natural remedies from plants .However for development of rural tribes and to conserve their knowledge under intellectual property right a vast effort is needed. Acknowledgements I am very much thankful to my teachers, seniors and friends of University of North Bengal for their valuable advice and suggestions. I am also thankful to traditional healers of this area for their kind help and suggestions. 57 58 References Bennet,S.S.R. 1987 .Name Changes in Flowering Plants of India and Adjacent Regions,Triseas Publishers,Dehra Dun,India. Bhardwaj, Ujala; Tiwari, B.K.; Prasad, Arun and Ganguly, Subha (2011) Study on the post-inoculation histopathilogical effect of Tinospora cordifolia extract in skin of broiler chicks. Indian J.Vet.Pathol. 35(2):225-226. Kumari, R.; Prasad, A.; Tiwari, B.K. and Ganguly, S. (2011) Oroxylum indicum possess a potential effect on humoral and cell mediated immune response in broiler chicks. Indian J. Anim.Sci. 81(12): 22-24. Kumari, R.; Tiwari, B.K.; Prasad, A. and Ganguly, S. (2011) Immunomodulatory effect of herbal feed supplement in normal and immunocompromised broiler chicks. Indian J.Anim.Sci. 81(2):158-161. Mathias-Mundy, E. and C. M. McCorkle, 1989. Ethnoveterinary medicine: an annotated bibliography. Bibliographies in Technology and Social Change, No.6, p.199. Technology and Social Change Program, Iowa State University, Ames, Iowa 50011. USA. Mondal, T. and S. Biswas (2012). Documentation of some ethno-veterinary medicinal plants of Bankura District, West Bengal,India.Life sciences Leaflets 6 : 4246,2012. Prain, D.1996.Bengal Plants (Vol 1 & 2),Bishen Singh Mahendra Pal Singh, Dehra Dun ,India. Tabuti, J.R.S., S.S. Dhillion and K.A. Lye, 2003. Ethno veterinary medicine for cattle (Bos indicus) in Bulamogi county Uganda: plant species and mode of use. J.Ethnopharmacol. 88:279-286. 58 59 Journal of Today’s Biological Sciences: Research & Review (JTBSRR) ISSN 2320-1444 (Online) JTBSRR Vol.1, Issue 1, page 59-66, December 30, 2012 Available on: www.jtbsrr.in Induction of Chitinase and Β-1, 3-Glucanase PR Proteins in Tomato through Liquid Formulated Bacillus Subtilis EPCO 16 against Fusarium Wilt SA. Ramyabharathi*, B. Meena and T. Raguchander Department of Plant Pathology, Tamil Nadu Agricultural University, Coimbatore – 641 003, Tamil Nadu, India. * Corresponding author: ramyabharu@gmail.com Abstract The effect of biocontrol agent Bacillus subtilis EPCO 16 on the induction of defense enzymes chitinase and β-1,3-glucanase in tomato plants infected with Fusarium oxysporum f. sp. lycopersici was investigated. The defense related proteins viz., chitinase and β-1,3-glucanase were analysed spectrophotometrically. The maximum activity of these defense enzymes was observed in seedling dip, soil application and foliar spray with B. subtilis EPCO 16 liquid formulation in tomato plants challenged with the pathogen. Activities of these defense enzymes reached maximum at the 7th day after challenge inoculation with pathogen. The results demonstrated that both the defense enzymes might play a special role in pathogenesis during fungal infection. Keywords Fusarium wilt, Bacillus subtilis, PR Proteins Introduction Tomato (Solanum lycopersicum L.), a crop of high economic importance is the second most important vegetable in the world after potato. Among the various biotic factors affecting tomato, soil borne diseases are playing a major role in drastic yield reduction (Lukyanenko, 1991). In India, the yield loss up to 45 per 59 60 cent was recorded due to Fusarium oxysporum f. sp. lycopersici. Use of chemicals against soil borne pathogens leads to environmental pollution and toxic effects on human health and give possibility to pathogens for building-up resistance to chemicals. Hence biological control agents creating a more long lasting effect is a necessity besides their antiphytopathogenic potential of soils. The biocontrol agent, Bacillus subtilis produces several classes of broad spectrum lipopeptides antibiotics which are effective suppressors of many plant pathogens, including species of Fusarium, Pythium, Phytophthora, Rhizoctonia, Sclerotinia, Septoria and Verticillium (Ongena and Jacques, 2008). Manikandan et al. (2010) reported that the use of liquid bioformulation on tomato plants decreased the Fusarium wilt incidence due to the induction of defense enzymes. Collective function of several PR Proteins may be effective in inhibiting pathogen growth, multiplication and spread of pathogen and be responsible for the state of induced resistance (van Loon, 1997). Hence present study was undertaken to evaluate the induction of defense enzymes by the application of bioformulation against Fusarium wilt of tomato. Materials and methods The laboratory and greenhouse experiments were conducted at the Department of Plant Pathology, Tamil Nadu Agricultural University, Coimbatore, India. The seeds of tomato cv. PKM1 was obtained from the Department of Vegetable Crops, Horticultural College and Research Institute, Tamil Nadu Agricultural University, Coimbatore and used throughout the experiment. Authenticated Bacillus subtilis EPCO 16 strain (Accession Number EF139864) was obtained from the Culture Collection Centre of the Department of Plant Pathology, Tamil Nadu Agricultural University, Coimbatore, India and was used for all the studies conducted in this investigation. Root priming of tomato seedlings with B. subtilis EPCO 16 Test bacterial strain EPCO 16 was cultured onto conical flasks containing 100 ml of L.B. broth media and kept in incubator at 35oC for 24 hours with agitation. After incubation, material was taken out from flask and centrifuged at 4000 rpm. Supernatant was discarded and bacterial cells were collected from the pellet. Inoculum of bacterial cells was prepared in liquid and talc formulation. Roots of seedlings were primed with EPCO 16 in liquid and talc formulation and in mancozeb by keeping for 30 minutes. After this the seedlings were transferred in pots. 60 61 Pathogen inoculation The fungi viz., F. oxysporum f.sp. lycopersici was mass multiplied separately in sand maize medium. Two months old plants maintained in earthenware pot (two feet diameter) at the rate of three seedlings per pot were inoculated with pathogens multiplied in sand maize medium. The pathogen F. oxysporum f.sp. lycopersici was inoculated separately in different pots grown with tomato plants @ 5 per cent (w/w) around collar region. Assay of defense-related enzymes Samples were collected from individual treatments to study the induction of defense enzymes in response to foliar as well as soil borne pathogens in tomato plants under glass house conditions. Leaves and roots from treated plants were collected starting from 1st day upto 9th day at 48 h intervals. The leaves were collected from treated and control tomato plants and immediately extracted with 2 ml of 0.1 M sodium citrate buffer (pH 5.0) at 4°C. The homogenate was centrifuged for 20 min at 10,000 rpm. Protein extracts prepared from tomato tissues were used for estimation of defense enzymes. Preparation of Colloidal chitin Colloidal chitin was prepared by treating 1 g of crab-shell chitin powder with acetone to form a paste and then slowly adding 20 ml of concentrated hydrochloric acid (HCl) while grinding in a mortar with the temperature maintained at 5C. The syrupy liquid was filtered through glass wool and poured into vigorously stirred 50 per cent aqueous ethanol to precipitate the chitin in a highly dispersed state. The residue was sedimented and resuspended in distilled water several times to remove excess acid and alcohol and then dialysed against tap water. Chitin content of the suspension was determined by drying a sample in vacuo and adjusted with distilled water to a final concentration of 10 mg ml-1 (dry weight/volume) and stored at 5C for further use (Berger and Reynolds, 1958). Preparation of snail gut enzyme Six hundred mg of the commercial lyophilized snail gut enzyme (Helicase, Sepracor, France) was dissolved in 10 ml of 20 mM potassium chloride (KCl) and chromatographed on a Sephadex G-25 column (38 x1.5 cm) using a 10 mM KCl solution, containing 1 mM EDTA and adjusted to pH 6.8 for equilibration and elution. The first 20 ml eluted after the void volume was collected (Boller and Mauch, 1988). 61 62 Preparation of p-dimethyl aminobenzaldehyde (DMAB) reagent The DMAB reagent was prepared by the procedure described by Reissig et al. (1955). Stock solution of DMAB was prepared by mixing 8 g of DMAB in 70 ml of glacial acetic acid along with 10 ml of concentrated HCl. One volume of stock solution was mixed with 9 volumes of glacial acetic acid immediately before use. Assay The reaction mixture consisted of 10 µl of 0.1 M sodium acetate buffer (pH 4.0), 0.4 ml enzyme solution and 0.1 ml colloidal chitin. After incubation for 2 h at 37° C, the reaction was stopped by centrifugation at 5000 rpm for 3 min. An aliquot of the supernatant (0.3 ml) was pipetted into a glass reagent tube containing 30 µl of 1 M potassium phosphate buffer (pH 7.0) and incubated with 20 µl of 3% (w/v) snail gut enzyme for 1 h. After 1 h, the reaction mixture was brought to pH 8.9 by the addition of 70 µl of 0.1 M sodium borate buffer (pH 9.8). The mixture was incubated in a boiling water bath for 3 min. and then rapidly cooled in an ice-water bath. After addition of 2 ml of DMAB, the mixture was incubated for 20 min. at 37°C. Immediately thereafter, the absorbance was measured at 585 nm. N-acetylglucosamine (GlcNAc) was used as a standard and the enzyme activity was expressed as nmoles GlcNAc equivalents min-1 g-1 fresh weight. Assay of β-1, 3 glucanase One gram of tomato seedling root tissue was extracted in 5 ml of 0.05 M sodium acetate buffer (pH 5.0). The homogenate was centrifuged at 10,000 rpm for 10 min. at 4C and the supernatant was used as enzyme source. -1,3-glucanase activity was assayed by the laminarin-dinitrosalicylic acid method (Pan et al., 1991). The reaction mixture consisted of 62.5 l of 4% laminarin (Sigma) and 62.5 l of enzyme extract. The reaction was carried out at 40C for 10 min. The reaction was stopped by adding 375µl of dinitrosalicylic acid and heated for 5 min in boiling water, vortexed and its absorbance was measured at 500 nm. The enzyme activity was expressed as g glucose released min-1 mg-1 of sample. Statistical Analysis The data were statistically analyzed using the IRRISTAT version 92 developed by the International Rice Research Institute Biometrics unit, the Philippines (Gomez and Gomez, 1984). Data were subjected to analysis of variance (ANOVA) at two significant levels (P<0.05 and P < 0.01) and means were compared by Duncan’s Multiple Range Test (DMRT). 62 63 Results and Discussion Synthesis and accumulation of PR proteins have been reported to play an important role in plant defense mechanisms. Chitinases (PR-3 protein) and -1,3glucanases (PR-2 protein) have been reported to associate with resistance in plants against pests and diseases (van Loon, 1997). In general, fungal cells contain chitin and glucan as their cell wall constituents. The main mode of antagonistic activity of microbes is production of lytic enzymes (chitinases and -1,3-glucanases) which act on cell walls or organisms which have chitin and glucan as their cell wall component (Singh et al., 1999) and also through induced systemic resistance (ISR) in plant system. In the present study, the elevated levels of chitinase and -1,3-glucanase in plants treated with bioformulation containing endophytic bacteria against pathogens was observed. Significant increase in 1,3-glucanase activity was observed in treatment with seedling dip, soil application and foliar spray of EPCO 16 liquid formulation (28.097) challenged with F. oxysporum followed by the same combination with talc formulation (23.652). These treatments recorded higher levels of -1,3-glucanase activity upto seven days challenged with Fusarium wilt pathogen and declined thereafter throughout the experimental period of nine days (Table 1). Elicitation of ISR in cotton by B. subtilis EPCO 102 with chitin led to the lowest bacterial blight incidence due to the induction of chitinase, -1,3-glucanase, peroxidase, polyphenol oxidase in cotton (Rajendran et al., 2006). Table 1. Induction of β-1,3-glucanase activity in tomato plants treated with Bacillus subtilis (EPCO 16) bioformulation challenged with F. oxysporum f. sp. lycopersici under glass house condition *Values are mean of three replications In a column, mean followed by a common letter are not significantly different at the 5% level by DMRT DAI – Days after inoculation LF - B. subtilis EPCO 16 liquid formulation, TF - B. subtilis EPCO 16 Talc formulation β-1,3-glucanase activity Treatments µmol equivalent glucose released/h/g of root tissue* 1 DAI Seedling dip with LF 6.175ab Seedling dip with TF 5.971b Seedling dip with 5.965b Mancozeb Seedling dip + soil 6.092ab application with LF 3 DAI 11.27c 8.270d 12.13b 5 DAI 14.00d 16.071c 13.960d 7 DAI 18.042d 21.276c 17.242d 9 DAI 16.521d 19.376c 15.691d 11.97bc 16.222c 23.392b 21.218b 63 64 Seedling dip + soil application with TF Seedling dip + soil application with Mancozeb Seedling dip + soil application + foliar spray with LF Seedling dip + soil application + foliar spray with TF Seedling dip + soil application + foliar spray with Mancozeb Inoculated Control Healthy control 6.357ab 12.47b 17.531b 24.650b 22.317b 6.175ab 11.27c 14.000d 18.042d 16.521d 6.523a 13.37a 20.260a 28.097a 24.375a 6.337ab 12.03b 16.532c 23.652b 22.218b 6.063b 12.23b 13.820d 18.232d 15.921d 5.220c 5.000c 5.200e 5.030e 5.223e 5.011e 5.225e 5.010e 5.200e 5.000e Chitinases are PR-proteins which hydrolyze chitin, a major cell wall component (3-10%) of higher fungi. Chitinases cleave a bond between C1 and C4 of two consecutive N-acetyl glucosamine (GlcNAc) either by endolytic or exolytic mechanisms. The treatment with seedling dip, soil application and foliar spray of liquid formulation of EPCO 16 led to the enhanced activity of chitinase compared to other treatments (Table 2). All the treatments were significantly different from control. In general, fungal cells contain chitin and glucan as their cell wall constituents. The main mode of antagonistic activity of microbes is production of lytic enzymes (chitinases and -1,3-glucanases) which act on cell walls or organisms which have chitin and glucan as their cell wall component (Singh et al., 1999) and also through induced systemic resistance (ISR) in plant system. Thus, in conclusion, the current study reveals the potential of liquid based formulation of B. subtilis EPCO 16 induces the plant’s own defense mechanism to suppress the Fusarium wilt of tomato. 64 65 Table 2. Induction of chitinase activity in tomato plants treated with B. subtilis (EPCO 16) bioformulation challenged with F. oxysporum f. sp. lycopersici under glass house condition *Values are means of three replications In a column, mean followed by a common letter are not significantly different at the 5% level by DMRT. DAI – Days after inoculation LF – B. subtilis EPCO 16 liquid formulation, TF - B. subtilis EPCO 16 Talc formulation Chitinase activity Treatments (mol of GlcNAc equivalent/min/g of fresh tissue)* 1 DAI 3 DAI 5 DAI 7 DAI 9 DAI d d d a Seedling dip with LF 59.213 79.300 89.400 98.900 90.100d Seedling dip with TF 59.010d 69.126e 79.083e 89.100b 90.020d Seedling dip with Mancozeb 47.213e 57.213f 69.103f 77.766c 72.010e Seedling dip + soil application with 62.900b 88.620abc 98.300ab 99.333a 91.200cd LF Seedling dip + soil application with 60.366cd 87.316bc 93.433c 99.000a 92.216bc TF Seedling dip + soil application with 59.800d 89.143a 97.433b 98.500a 92.176bc Mancozeb Seedling dip + soil application + 65.900a 89.726a 99.233a 99.456a 96.333a foliar spray with LF Seedling dip + soil application + 65.420a 88.866ab 97.816ab 99.233a 93.523b foliar spray with TF Seedling dip + soil application + 61.800bc 87.100c 92.300c 99.400a 90.083d foliar spray with Mancozeb Inoculated Control 38.333g 39.416h 41.203h 42.400e 45.010g Healthy control 40.113f 49.226g 58.126g 58.833d 60.033f References Berger, L.R. and Reynolds, D.M. 1958. The chitinase system of a strain of Streptomyces griseus. Biochem. Biophy. Acta., 29: 522-534. Boller, T. and Mauch, F. 1988. Colorimetric assay for chitinase. Meth. Enzymol., 161: 430-435. Gomez, K.A. and Gomez, A.A. 1984. Statistical Procedures for Agricultural Research. John Wiley and Sons, New York. p.680. 65 66 Lukyanenko, A.N. 1991. Disease resistance. In : Monographs on theoretical and applied genetics -14. (Ed.G.Kello). Springer Verlag, Berlin Heidelberg, pp.99-119. Manikandan, R., Saravanakumar, D., Rajendran, L., Raguchander, T. and Samiyappan, R. 2010. Standardization of liquid formulation of Pseudomonas fluorescens Pf1 for its efficacy against Fusarium wilt of tomato. Biological Control, 54: 83–89. Ongena, M. and Jacques, P. 2008. Bacillus lipopeptides : versatile weapons for plant disease biocontrol. Trends in Microbiology, 16: 115–125. Pan, S.Q., Ye, X.S. and Kuc, J. 1991. Association of β-1,3-glucanase activity and isoform pattern with systemic resistance to blue mold in tobacco induced by stem injection with Peronospora tabacina or leaf inoculation with tobacco mosaic virus. Physiol. Mol. Plant Pathol., 39: 25-39. Rajendran, L., Saravanakumar, D., Raguchander, T. and Samiyappan, R. 2006. Endophytic bacterial induction of defence enzymes against bacterial blight of cotton. Phytopathol. Mediterr., 45: 203–214. Reissig, J.L., Strominger, J.L. and Leloir, L.F. 1955. A modified method for the estimation of N-acetyl amino sugars. J. Biol. Chem., 217: 959-966. Singh, P.P., Shin, Y.C., Park, C.S. and Chung, Y.R. 1999. Biological control of Fusarium wilt of cucumber by chitinolytic bacteria. Phytopathology, 89: 92-99. van Loon, L.C.1997. Induced resistance in plants and the role of pathogenesisrelated proteins. European J. Plant Pathol., 103: 753–765. 66 67 Journal of Today’s Biological Sciences: Research & Review (JTBSRR) ISSN 2320-1444 (Online) JTBSRR Vol.1, Issue 1, page 67-86 December 30, 2012 Available on: www.jtbsrr.in In vitro regeneration and genetic transformation in groundnut (Arachis hypogaea L. cv. Smruti) for abiotic stress tolerance mediated by Agrobacterium tumefaciens Kusum Rana and I.C.Mohanty* Department of Agricultural Biotechnology, College of Agriculture Orissa University of Agriculture and Technology Bhubaneswar, E.mail-icmohanty1@rediffmail.com * Corresponding Author Abstract Genetic improvement of Groundnut through genetic engineering of plant for tolerance to moisture stress could be achieved by the regulated expression of a large number of stress responsive genes. In plant, one transcription factor DREB1A/CBF3 controls the expression of many target genes through the specific binding of the transcription factor to the cis-acting element in promoters of the target genes (Ingram and Bartels, 1996; Shinozaki et al., 2000). The present research aimed at developing an efficient regeneration system of Groundnut cv. Smruti, performing Agrobacterium-mediated transformation of Groundnut with rd29::CBF3 gene and screening of putative transformants by kanamycin based selection system. Different explants namely, cotyledon, leaf and stem segments were used to study the in vitro plant regeneration of groundnut (Arachis hypogaea L.). All the explants were cultured in MS medium with different concentrations of 2, 4-D, and NAA. Leaf explants showed better performances than cotyledon and stem. Among different concentrations, 2, 4-D @ 2mg/l was found more suitable for good callus induction. When enriched with a cytokinin (Kinetin, 0.5 mg/l), the same medium produced quick, nodular, brownish friable good callus. MS medium supplemented with different concentrations of BAP produced small shoot bud at different subcultures. Enriched with NAA (0.5 mg/l), MS basal nutrient medium with BAP (2.0 mg/l) produced high frequency plantlets from callus cultures. Direct organogenesis was also achieved with the same medium from de-embryonated cotyledonary segments. Shoot 67 68 were rooted on MS medium supplemented with 1.5 mg/l NAA. De-embryonated cotyledon explants of Groundnut were transformed using Agrobacterium tumefacience strain GV3107 with the binary vector pCAMBIA2300 containing the gene for increasing tolerance to moisture stress, CBF3 driven by a stress inducible promoter rd29A. For the selection of transformed plants, lethal dose of kanamycin was optimized and was found to be 60mg/l. A transformation frequency of 12.5% was achieved after 3rd round of selection based on nptII selectable marker gene evaluated against the antibiotic kanamycin at 80mg/l in the in vitro culture medium. Key words: Groundnut, In vitro regeneration, genetic transformation, Agrobacterium Introduction Groundnut (Arachis hypogaea L. ; Family: Fabaceae, 2n=4x=40) is a major oilseed crop cultivated largely in many tropical, sub-tropical and warm temperate regions of the world. Groundnut is grown mainly for human consumption in the form of seeds and for vegetable oil and a rich source of protein, lipids, and dietary energy. The global production of peanut averages nearly 26.38 million metric tones from almost 20 million hectare, with the annual production of 36.06 million tons of nuts-in-shells. The total area under groundnut cultivation in India is 8.0 million hectares which accounts for the total production of 7.5 million tons with the productivity of 937.5 Kg ha-1 (FAO Database, 2008). Its yield is vulnerable to a variety of biotic and abiotic constraints (Nageshwara Rao and Nigam, 2001) & (Ghewande et al. 2002a). Among the abiotic stresses, soil moisture deficit at various stages of crop growth during rainy season and low temperature during germination and vegetative stage but high temperature during the pod filling and maturation stage during summer hampers the productivity. The procedures and objectives for peanut improvement programs largely depend on the use of the crop, whether for oil or food, and on the amount of the inputs used in production. When grown as a subsistence crop by low-resource farmers, measures to manipulate stresses are no longer cost effective. Under these conditions, the crop by itself must be tolerant to a range of biotic and abiotic stresses if adequate yields are desired. Conventional breeding has led to the improvement of few peanut traits like seed yield and drought tolerance. However, due to its limited applicability, many of the important agronomic traits have yet to be improved. Although the genetic variability within wild species includes many of these valuable traits, wide hybridization in peanut has limited applicability due to cross incompatibility, low frequency to produce hybrid seeds and linkages with undesired traits. Genetic transformation offers a solution by 68 69 making the transfer of genes from alien sources feasible for generating transgenic plants possessing resistance to biotic & abiotic stresses. Initial attempts to develop transgenics for abiotic stress tolerance involved single action genes i.e. genes responsible for modification of a single metabolite that would confer increased tolerance to salt or drought stress. But abiotic stress tolerance is likely to involve many genes at a time and single gene tolerance is unlikely to be sustainable. Therefore, genetic engineering with regulatory proteins/ transcription factors has emerged as a new tool for controlling the expression of many stress-responsive genes. Through these proteins, many genes involved in stress response can be simultaneously regulated by a single gene encoding stress inducible transcription factor (Kasuga et al. 1999), thus offering possibility of enhancing tolerance towards multiple stresses including drought, salinity and freezing. In plant, one transcription factor can control the expression of many target genes through the specific binding of the transcription factor to the cisacting element in promoters of the target genes (Ingram and Bartels, 1996; Shinozaki et al., 2000). Several cDNAs encoding the dehydration responsive elements (DRE) binding proteins, DREB1A and DREB2A have been isolated from A. thaliana and shown to specifically bind and activate the transcription of genes containing DRE sequences (Liu et al.1998). Over expression of DREB1A/CBF3 in transgenic Arabidopsis plant showed increased tolerance to freezing, drought and high salt concentration, suggesting that the DREB 1A/CBF3 proteins function without modification of the proteins in the development of stress tolerance. Strong and constitutive promoters are beneficial for high level expression of selectable marker genes which is necessary for efficient selection and generation of transgenic plants. Constitutively active promoters are not always desirable for plant genetic engineering because over expression of a transgene may compete for energy and building blocks for synthesis of proteins or RNA that are also required for plant growth under normal conditions. Over expression of Arabidopsis DREB1/CBF3 gene also causes severe growth retardation under normal growth conditions. Use of a stress inducible rd29A promoter instead of the constitutive CaMV35S promoter for over expression DREB1A/CBF3 minimizes negative effects on plant growth (Kasuga et al., 1999). A variety of techniques for plant transformation are available, these techniques can be split into two groups: Agrobacterium mediated transformation and direct gene transfer methods such as particle bombardment, electroporation, microinjection etc. Agrobacterium mediated transformation is widely used with the dicotyledonous crops, which reflects the natural host range of members of the genus Agrobacterium. Direct gene transfer methods are most commonly used to transform monocotyledonous crops such as cereals. Successful genetic transformation of plants generally requires a well-established tissue culture 69 70 system to regenerate whole plants from single cells. Gene transfer through single cell-originated somatic embryogenesis yielded gene transfer into each cells of regenerated plants with higher transformation frequencies without chimeric variations (Wilkins et al., 2004. Hence, the present research aimed at developing an efficient in vitro regeneration and transformation system in groundnut with rd29A::DREB1A gene construct. Materials and methods Materials used The high yielding popular groundnut variety Smruti collected from the Breeder, Groundnut, Dean of Research, Orissa University of Agriculture and Technology, Bhubaneswar was used as the source of explants and Agrobacterium tumefaciens strain GV 3107 harboring binary vector of pCAMBIA2300 with the gene construct (IARI, New Delhi) (Fig.1) under MOU were used in the investigation. Fig.1. Gene Construct and Restriction Map of DREB1a gene Culture media and Growth regulators The culture medium used in the plant tissue culture was MS medium (Murashige and Skoog, 1962). Benzyl Amino Purine (BAP), Naphthalene Acetic Acid (NAA), Kinetin and 2, 4-D all from HIMEDIA were used as growth regulators. Agrobacterium strain GV3107 harboring DREB1a gene was cultured in liquid YEMA (Yeast Extract Mannitol Agar) medium supplemented with 10mg/l Kanamycin, 50mg/l Rifampicin. The YEMA culture was incubated at 28 º C for optimum growth of bacteria. Restriction Enzymes like BamH1 and Sac1 from GENEI, Bangalore were used for restriction digestion analysis. 70 71 Callus induction Three different explants (cotyledons, stem, & leaf) were excised from 10-day-old aseptically grown seedlings and were cultured on MS medium which was subjected to different concentrations of 2, 4-D (0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0mg/l) and 0.5mg/l KIN for callus induction. The explants were begun to enlarge within 13th day of culture initiation. Shoot bud regeneration Calli from cotyledon were cultured on MS-medium supplemented with varying concentrations of BAP (1.0, 1.5, 2.0, 2.5mg/l) or Kinetin (1.0, 2.0mg/l) in combination with NAA (0.5mg/l) individually for shoot bud differentiation and plant regeneration. De-embryonated cotyledonary segments were also used for direct regeneration. Shoots and buds formed in a cluster from callus as well as directly from cotyledons were separated into smaller clumps and sub cultured on MS- medium containing BAP (1.0, 1.5, 2.0, 2.5mg/l) or Kinetin (1.0, 2.0mg/l) in combination with NAA, IAA for further growth and shoot multiplication. Later, shoots were separated and transferred to fresh medium for micro propagation and production of uniform sized plantlets. Root induction and hardening The regenerated elongated micro shoots (>3 cm in length) were excised and planted on MS-medium supplemented with NAA (0.5, 1.0mg/l) for root induction. Plantlets with well developed roots were removed from the culture tubes and, after washing roots in running tap water were transferred to beakers containing water for pre hardening. After 1 day the rooted shoots were transferred to plastic cups containing soil, sand and compost in the ratio of 1:1:1 in a growth chamber. Subsequently, the plantlets were transferred to field conditions, where they flowered and set viable seeds. Optimization of a kanamycin based selection system In order to determine the lethal dose of the antibiotic, kanamycin on shoot proliferation and plant regeneration, the primary shoot obtained after 2 weeks of culture on shoot induction media described as above were transferred to fresh shoot induction media supplemented with different concentrations of kanamycin (20, 40, 60 and 80 mg/l). The viability of regenerated shoots was observed after 1, 2 and 3weeks. Validation of DREB1A gene in recombinant pCambia2300 vector Isolation of plasmid from Agrobacterium tumefeciencs strain GV 3107 Alkali lysis method was used for isolation of plasmid from GV3107 cells as was described by Sambrook et al.(1989). Single colonies were picked and grown in 71 72 3ml of LB media with kanamycin (50mg/l), rifamycin (10mg/l) for 16h at 37˚C and the culture was centrifuged at 10000 rpm for 2 min a 4˚C. Restriction digestion of DNA Restriction digestion of plasmid DNA isolated from the bacterial colonies was done as per the standard procedure (Sambrook et al., 1989) using restriction endonuclease BamH1 and Sacl (Genei, Bangalore ) in an appropriate buffer at 37˚C for 1h.The digested products were analyzed on a 1.2% Agarose gel. Fig.2. Schematic map of vector of pCAMBIA2300 Agarose gel electrophoresis Required amount of Agarose was weighed (1.2%w/v) and melted in TBE buffer (0.9 M Tris borate, 0.002M EDTA, pH 8.2). Ethidium bromide was added at a final concentration of 0.5mg/ml. After cooling to 50-55˚C, the mixture was poured onto a preset template with an appropriate comb. The comb was removed after solidification and gel with template was placed in an electrophoresis chamber containing the running buffer (1X TBE). DNA to be analyzed was mixed with the gel loading buffer (6X buffer contain 0.25% bromophenol blue, 30% glycerol in water) at 5:1 ratio and loaded into the well. Electrophoresis was carried out at 50V (Sambrook et al., 1989). Agrobacterium-mediated transformation The genetic transformation of the explants was done by co-culturing with the Agrobacterium cultures. The cotyledons without embryogenic axis were excised aseptically and treated with Agrobacterium suspension for 30 minutes. After 72 73 immersion, excess bacterial suspension was removed by placing cotyledons on sterile tissue papers and the cotyledons were transferred and placed adaxial side in 30mmX25mm Petri plates having MS-medium supplemented with 30g/l sucrose, 2.0mg/l BAP, 0.5mg/l NAA, 6g/l agar: (pH5.8), overlaid with What man No.1 filter paper (wetted with 1.0 ml of MS-medium containing 10mg/l kanamycin) sealed with Para film and incubated at 25˚C for 3 days. The heavily infected explants were washed with 500mg/l cefotaxime solution and transferred to fresh multiple shoot induction medium containing 2.0mg/l BAP, 0.5mg/lNAA and 500mg/l cefotaxime. The explants exhibiting multiple shoot buds after 20 days were sub-cultured on MS medium containing 2.0mg/l BAP, 0.5mg/l NAA and 500mg/l cefotaxime. The well developed healthy shoots were transferred to MS medium containing 2.0mg/l BAP, 0.5mg/l NAA, 500mg/l cefotaxime and 60mg/l Kanamycin for rooting and selection of putative transgenics. The explants without co-cultured were used as negative control. The well developed shoots that survived the kanamycin selection were rooted on MS medium supplemented with 2.0mg/l NAA, 500mg/l cefotaxime and 60mg/l Kanamycin. Results and Discussion Morphogenetic responses of different explants on callus induction All the explants (Cotyledon, stem & leaf) produced callus when cultured on MS medium supplemented with different concentrations of 2, 4-D and KIN (0.5mg/l). The effect of different concentrations of 2, 4-D and Kinetin on callus induction of peanut are presented in Table 1. Friable, compact, light green, brownish and watery types of callus were observed irrespective of explants. These were maintained on the same medium by repeated sub culturing for further proliferation. Callus obtained from stem explants was brown, watery and friable (Fig. 3). Calli from leaf and cotyledon explants proliferated profusely and turned deep green and friable (Fig.3b). The highest frequency of callus induction observed was 90%, 90% and 100% in cotyledon, stem & leaf explants respectively. The best callus growth was obtained when 2, 4-D (2.0 mg/l) and 0.5 mg/l kinetin were used in the medium. 73 74 Table 1. Effect of phytohormones and explants on Callus induction in Groundnut (cv.SMRUTI, 10 days old seedling). Treatment Particulars of treatments Observation Explant Growth Days to % of medium callus callusing (MS+ induction Phytohormones) 2,4-D Kinetin Nature of callusing Callus type T-1 Leaf 0.5 0 28 25 (+)* T-2 Leaf 1.0 0 21 25 (++) T-3 Leaf 1.5 0 21 50 (++) T-4 Leaf 2.0 0 14 100 (++++) T-5 Leaf 0.5 0.5 20 30 (+) T-6 Leaf 1.0 0.5 20 40 (++) T-7 Leaf 1.5 0.5 15 40 (+++) T-8 Leaf 2.0 0.5 12 100 (++++) T-9 Cotyle don Cotyle 0.5 0 35 20 (+) 1.0 0 36 45 (++) Poor response, Poor growth Compact, greenish Unsatisfacto ry growth Light green, Compact Optimum growth Optimum growth Greenish,Po or growth Light green,comp act in middle & friable outside Green,Opti mum growth Brown, friable,loos e Optimum growth Poor growth Unsatisfacto T-10 74 75 T-11 don Cotyle don Cotyle don Cotyle don 1.5 0 28 45 (+++) 2.0 0 21 70 (+++) 0.5 0.5 35 55 (+) Cotyle don Cotyle don Cotyle don 1.0 0.5 34 55 (+) 1.5 0.5 20 85 (++++) 2.0 0.5 16 90 (+++) T-17 Stem 0.5 0 28 15 (+) T-18 Stem 1.0 0 28 75 (+) T-19 Stem 1.5 0 20 75 (+) T-20 Stem 2.0 0 18 90 (++) T-21 Stem 0.5 0.5 30 70 (+) T-22 Stem 1.0 0.5 24 70 (+) T-23 Stem 1.5 0.5 24 70 (++) T-24 Stem 2.0 0.5 18 85 (++) T-12 T-13 T-14 T-15 T-16 CV% CD (0.5) *+ : Poor ++ : Good 11.86 1.46 +++: Very good 75 ++++ : Excellent ry growth Optimum growth Optimum growth Compact, poor growth Non-friable, greenish White, friable White, friable, quick proliferatin g Compact, whitish Compact, Watery Compact, whitish Yellowish, friable Slow growing Brownish, watery Non-friable, green Yellowish, friable 76 a b c d Fig. 3. Effect of 2, 4-D on callus induction- a. sterile seedling, b. leaf ; c. cotyledon ; d. stem Shoot-bud regeneration and elongation Indirect Organogenesis After 4 weeks of culture, the well proliferated nodular, compact calli were subcultured two to three times in a reduced auxin containing medium. Afterward, these were transferred to a shoot induction medium containing different concentrations of BAP (1.0-2.5mg/l) in combination with graded doses of either NAA (0-1.0 mg/l) or IAA (0-1.0 mg/l) for shoot bud regeneration. The maximum percentage of calli having shoot bud was observed from the treatment of BAP (2.0 mg/l) and NAA (0.5 mg/l) (87.5%) followed by BAP (2.5 mg/l) and NAA (0.5 mg/l) (82.5% ) (Table 2). The highest mean number of shoots (22±1.5) obtained while using BAP (2.0 mg/l) and NAA (0.5 mg/l) (Table 2) followed by 18±1.4 no of shoots per culture in BAP (1.5 mg/l) and NAA (0.5 mg/l). 76 77 Table 2. Effect of phytohormones on shoot bud differentiation and elongation T3 2.0 0 _ 30 24 80.0 12±1.1 T4 2.5 0 _ 30 24 80.0 11±0.9 T5 1.0 0.5 _ 40 31 77.5 16±1.2 T6 1.5 0.5 _ 40 32 80.0 18±1.4 T7 2.0 0.5 _ 40 35 87.5 22±1.5 T8 2.5 0.5 _ 40 33 82.5 16±1.0 T9 1.0 1.0 _ 30 21 70.0 10±0.8 T10 1.5 1.0 _ 30 23 76.7 11±0.8 T11 2.0 1.0 _ 30 22 73.3 10±1.0 T12 2.5 1.0 _ 30 20 66.7 13±1.1 T13 1.0 _ 0.5 40 30 75.0 14±1.2 T14 1.5 _ 0.5 40 31 77.5 16±1.4 T15 2.0 _ 0.5 40 28 70.0 16±0.9 T16 2.5 _ 0.5 40 26 65.0 18±1.2 T17 1.0 _ 1.0 30 19 63.3 06±0.5 T18 1.5 _ 1.0 30 19 63.3 10±0.8 T19 2.0 _ 1.0 30 20 66.7 11±0.8 T20 2.5 _ 1.0 30 21 70.0 17±1.0 Treatment No.of shoots culture - T2 Treatment particulars Biometrical observations (MS+Phytohormones) BAP NAA IAA No.of No.of Rate of explants explants Regeneration cultured regenerated (%) 1.0 0 _ 30 No response 1.5 0 _ 30 21 70.0 T1 77 8±0.7 / 78 Direct Organogenesis Three different phytohormones were tested independently for their ability to induce organogenesis directly. Complete plants were regenerated from in vitro cultured sectioned de-embryonated cotyledonary segments. Multiple shoots arose on 6-benzylaminopurine (BAP) (1.0 – 2.50 mg/l) supplemented Murashige and Skoog’s medium with maximum production occurring at 2.0 mg/ l of BAP (Table-3a &b). This medium produced highest number of shoots per culture (12.1± 1.2) when enriched with NAA ( 0.5 mg/l) (Table 3b). Good callus growth with bud primordia was observed in MS medium supplemented with 2, 4-D (2.0 mg/l). Callus growth as well as shoot development was observed in case of BAP depending on the concentration. Slow callus growth was found at different concentrations of NAA. So, from the above study we can assume that among the different growth hormones tested for organogenesis, BAP was found to be more suitable for direct regeneration compared to 2,4-D and NAA. When cultured on only MS medium without hormone, none of the explants did show any response (callusing or shoot bud differentiation). When higher concentrations of BAP (2.0 to 2.5 mg/l) were used, the explants directly developed shoot bud. No callusing was observed in higher concentration of BAP. Table 3a. Effect of Phyto-hormones in MS medium on plant let differentiation in different explants of Groundnut (Direct Organogenesis) 2,4-D mg/l BAP mg/l 0.5 0 1.0 0 1.5 0 2.0 0 0 1.0 0 1.5 0 2.0 0 2.5 NAA Morphogenic response mg/l De-embryonated Leaf Cotyledonary segment 0 Slow callus growth Slow callus growth 0 Good callus growth Good callus growth 0 Good callus growth Quick, Good callus growth 0 Good callus growth Quick, Good callus growth 0 Swelling of the No. Response explants 0 Growth with shoot No. Response bud primordial 0 Only shoot developed Slow callus growth 0 Only shoot developed Slow callus 78 Stem Slow callus growth Good callus growth Good callus growth Quick, Good callus growth No. Response No. Response Slow growth Slow callus callus 79 0 0 0 0 0.5 1.0 No. Response Callus growth slow 0 0 1.5 Callus growth slow 0 0 2.0 Callus growth slow growth No. Response Poor response Callus slow Callus slow growth No. Response Poor response growth Callus slow growth Callus slow growth growth Treatm ent Table 3b. Effect of different concentrations of BAP and NAA on shoot regeneration from cotyledonal explants of Groundnut on MS medium (Direct Organogenesis) Combinations of Phytohormones (mg/l) BAP NAA Observation on shoot regeneration 1 0.5 0 Regeneratio n rate (%) No response 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.5 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.5 0 0 0 0 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 47 64 72 75 38 53 61 87 75 9 10 No.of shoots/ Shoot culture* length*(cm) 2.3±0.3 2.5±0.7 5.7±0.8 4.8±0.2 1.6±0.2 2.6±0.3 3.7±0.4 0.4±0.1 0.6±0.1 1.0±0.1 0.8±0.2 0.8±0.1 1.1±0.1 1.1±0.1 12.1±1.2 8.8±0.2 1.6±0.3 0.8±0.1 * Values represent the mean ± standard deviation Rooting and hardening The healthy shoots were transferred to rooting MS medium containing NAA (0.5-2.0mg/l). The development of small primary roots was observed within 4-5 days of transfer into rooting medium. After 15 days all the healthy primary roots showed formation of secondary roots. All the shoots successfully produced roots without any deformity. In earlier reports only 0.5 mg/l was used for rooting (Sharma and Anjaiah, 2000). Hundred percent rooting was observed in the present study as all the plants rooted successfully, this could be due to the high concentration of NAA (1.50 mg/l) used (Table 4).The rooted plantlets were removed from the in vitro system and were maintained in the pots containing 79 80 sterile soil substrate. The sand and soil ratio was maintained properly for the mixture used in pots; which helped in the proper seepage and no stagnation of water in pots. The sand soil mixture was autoclaved before use so as to eliminate any pathogen present in soil. The Hoagland nutrient solution was used for watering the plants taken for hardening which nourished the plants in the early days of plant establishment (Radhakrishnan et al., 1999). Table 4. Effect of PGRs on rhizogenesis Treatment Days to root induction MS-media + 0.5 mg/l NAA 14-16 MS- media + 1.0 mg/l NAA 15-19 MS- media + 1.5 mg/l NAA 12-20 MS- media + 2.0 mg/l NAA 13-17 Percentage of Response 43.16 70.59 84.72 67.30 Optimization of kanamycin based selection system Different graded doses of kanamycin were taken in the regeneration medium to find out the toxic level that would suppress the normal growth of the plantlets in vitro. The cotyledons were first stabilized in MS-medium containing 2.0mg/l BAP +NAA 0.5mg/l without kanamycin for 7 days and then transferred to the MS-medium + 2.0 mg/l BAP +NAA 0.5mg/l medium containing various concentrations of kanamycin for the optimization of the concentration of kanamycin capable of inihibiting the plant growth. The effect of kanamycin was only observed at the concentrations above 30 mg/l on the shootlets with yellow sectorial patches on leaves and at the concentration of 60 mg/l, the growth was suspended and caused drastic decrease in the frequency of regeneration from 100% to 60% as well as number of shoots per explants and caused more than 50% necrosis in the regenerated shoots (Table 5). Thus, 60 mg/l kanamycin was determined as the minimum concentration suitable for selection of putative transformed shoots. This optimized antibiotic selection scheme eliminates the regeneration of non-transformed escapes and discriminates between resistant and non-resistant plantlets. 80 81 Table 5. Effect of different concentrations of kanamycin on in vitro shoot regeneration of groundnut cv. SMRUTI after 2weeks of shoot initiation. Sl. No. Kanamycin ( mg/l) No. of explants cultured in kanamycin media No. of explants inducing green shoots Regeneration rate (%) No. of shoots/explant Green & Yellow & Healthy necrotic shoots(a) shoots(b) Kanamycin susceptible shoots % (b/a+b)*100 1 0 10 10 100 12 0 0 2 20 10 10 100 13 0 0 3 30 10 8 80 06 04 40 4 40 10 5 50 06 05 45 5 50 10 6 60 04 03 43 6 60 10 6 60 05 08 61 7 70 10 3 30 0 05 100 8 80 10 1 10 0 02 100 Validation of DREB1A gene in recombinant pCambia2300 vector Double digestion released AtDREB1A gene (642bp) insert from pCAMBIA 2300 vector . a c b d e Fig. 4. Organogenesis(a-b: indirect; c-d: direct from cotyledon explants; e: rhyzogenesis) 81 82 Transformation The de-embryonated cotyledon segments which were taken for co-cultivation with strain GV 3107 containing the gene construct were treated by dipping in the bacterial suspension for 5 minutes , then cultured for 3 days in shooting medium without selection pressure and subsequently were grown on culture medium containing 30mg/l kanamycin and 500 mg/l cefotaxime. Multiple shoots were initiated in the cotyledon after 3 weeks of culture. Multiple shoots were subcultured after every 2 weeks on selection medium by increasing concentration of kanamycin from 30 to 60 mg/l and then to 80mg/l. The growth of kanamycin resistance shoots was rapid. Kanamycin resistant shoots were subjected to further high selection pressure and were maintained for evaluation in transgenic green house. b a Fig. 5. Hardening(a: pre-hardening; b: post-hardening) Table 6. Agrobacterium-mediated transformation of groundnut cultivar Smruti using de-embryonated cotyledon. Gene construct Used No. of explant cocultivated No. of explants regenerated No of shoot buds No. of lines survived after third selection Transformation efficiency (%) based on kanamycin selection (80mg/l) pCambia2300 120 84 327 41 12.53 (DREB1a) 82 83 a b c d Fig. 6. Normal growth inhibition due to Kanamycin ( a-0mg/l ;b-30mg/l ; c- 60mg/l ; d-100mg/) Development of an efficient plant regeneration system The success of transgenic research in crop improvement demands an efficient in vitro culture system for obtaining high frequency plant regeneration from the target tissue of the genotype concerned. In vitro plant regeneration can be accomplished through somatic embryogenesis or organogenesis. During last decade, peanut regeneration through organogenesis/somatic embryogenesis has vastly increased by using different explants. The frequency of plantlet regeneration in all these protocols being quite low has deferred their usage for genetic transformation studies. Besides, the in vitro regeneration in groundnut is found to be dependent on particular genotype and type of explants. Even though there are several reports presented for direct and indirect regeneration, there are no reports presented for the comparative studies of groundnut regeneration. Hence, this present research work was aimed to standardize the simple reliable protocol for direct and indirect regeneration of groundnut in the high yielding cultivar Smruti adaptable to various agroclimatic situations of the state. In vitro regeneration following an interveining callus phase was first tried in this crop. A combination of higher auxins and lower level of cytokinin results in effective callus formation. Therefore, kinetin at 0.5 mg/l was added to increase the frequency of callusing. These results are in agreement with the findings of Bajaj et al (1981), Narasimhulu and Reddy (1983), and Venkatachalam et al. (1994) in groundnut. Callus initiation from cotyledon explant took longer in comparison to that in leaf and stem. Results obtained from this experiment revealed that groundnut leaf explants followed by cotyledon were found to be best suitable for callus induction and 2, 4-D @ 2.0mg/l was found to be the best concentration for maximum frequency of callus induction. The well proliferated nodular, compact calli obtained after frequent subculture were transfered to a shoot induction medium and the basal salts of MS fortified with BAP (2.0 mg/l) and NAA (0.5 mg/l) was found to be the best combination for the purpose. However direct organogenesis reduces the duration of exposure of the explants to the culture environment and therefore reduces the risk of occurrences of 83 84 somaclonal variation in regenerated plantlets which may scramble up the gene construct used for genetic transformation. It was designed to assess the direct regeneration response in vitro of different explants like leaf, stem and deembryonated cotyledonary segments without an intervening callus phase in the MS nutrient medium fortified with different concentrations of cytokinin (BAP) and auxins (2,4-D and NAA) separately and later BAP with NAA in combination (Table-3a&b). Again, the MS basal salts supplemented with BAP (2.0mg/l) and NAA (0.5 mg/l) was reported to be the best combination for direct organogenesis. The classical findings of Skoog and Miller (1957) that organogenesis in tissue cultures is governed by the balance of auxin and cytokinin in the medium could be well demonstrated. The cytokinin (BAP) enhanced shoot bud formation in cultured callus of Arachis hypogaea is in accordance with previous reports on groundnut (Mrogniski et al., 1981; Banerjee et al., 1988; McKently et al., 1990; Cheng et al., 1992; Eapen and George, 1993). The combinations of auxins and cytokinins at definite proportions are very critical and found to be essential for the induction of shoot bud in groundnut (Mroginski et al., 1981; Narasimhulu and Reddy. 1983; Banerjee et aL, 1988; McKently et aL, 1990; Cheng et aL, 1992; Eapen and George, 1993; Venkatachalam et al., 1994). However, the procedure and efficiency of Groundnut plant regeneration was complicated and even not easily available to the scientists yet. A simple and efficient method for the regeneration of autonomous plants from tissue culture is essential to establish a genetic transformation protocol for Groundnut. Agrobacterium tumefaciens mediated genetic transformation of groundnut has been reported by several groups (Mc Kently et al., 1995; Cheng et al., 1996; Li et al., 1997; Tiwari et al., 2008). However, in the present study, a transformation frequency of 12.5% was achieved after 3rd round of selection at kanamycin 80mg/l (Table 6). Here, the kanamycin based selection system was used for the screening of the putative transformants where some false possitives might have escaped. However, these putative transformants need to be screened further by employing other powerful techniques like PCR and southern blotting and subsequently bioassay in the transgenic green house to obtain the groundnut plants showing tolerance to moisture stress. Acknowledgements We sincerely acknowledge the DBT for making financial provision for this research. We thankfully acknowledge the help rendered by IARI, New Delhi in providing the gene construct for the research. 84 85 References Cheng M, Hsi DC, Phillips GC (1992) In vitro regeneration of valencia type peanut (Arachis hypogaea L.) from cultured petioles, epicotyle section and other seedling explants. Peanut Science. 19: 82-87. Cheng M, Jarret RL, Li Z, Xing A, Demski JN (1996) Production of fertile transgenic peanut plants generated by Agrobacterium tumefaciens. Plant cell Report. 15: 653-657. Eapen S, George L (1994) Agrobacterium tumefaciens-mediated gene transformation in Peanut (Arachis hypogaea L.). Plant cell Report. 13: 582-586. Egnin M, Mora A, Prakash CS (1998) Factors enhancing Agrobacterium tumefaciens mediated gene transfer in peanut (Arachis hypogaea L.). In Vitro Cellular and Developmental Biology Plant. 34: 4, 310-318. Grant JE, Cooper PA, Gilpin BJ, Hoglund SJ , Reader JK, PitherJoyee MD, Timmerman-Vaughan GM (1998) Kanamycin is effective for selecting transformed peas. Plant Sci. 139:159-164. McKently AH, Moore GA, Doostdar H, Neidz RP (1995) Agrobacterium mediated transformation of peanut (Arachis hypogaea L.) embryo axes and the development of transgenic plants. Plant Cell Report. 14: 699-703. Nageswararao RC, Nigam SN (2001) Genetic options for drought management in groundnut. In “Management of Agricultural Drought; Agronomic and genetic options” (N. P. Saxena ed.). Oxford and IBH Publishing Co., New Delhi. Radhakrishnan T, Murthy TGK, Bandyopadhyay A (1999) Multiple shoot induction in groundnut (Arachis hypogaea L.). In: Plant Physiology for Agriculture (Eds. Srivastava, G. C., Singh,K. and Pal, M.). Ponter Publishers, Jaipur, India. pp. 433-439. Sharma KK, Anjaiah V (2000) An efficient method for the production of transgenic plants of peanut through Agrobacterium tumefaciens mediated genetic transformation. Plant Science. 159: 7-19. Sharma KK, Lavanya M (2002) Recent developments in transgenics for abiotic stress in legumes of the semi-arid tropics. Genetic engineering of crop plants for abiotic stress. Proceedings of an APECJIRCAS joint symposium and workshop, Bangkok, Thailand, 3-7 September 2001. JIRCAS Working Report. 23:61-73. 85 86 Venkatachalam P, Geetha N, Jayabalan N, Sita L (1998) Agrobacterium-mediated genetic transformation of groundnut (Arachis hypogaea L.): an assessment of factors affecting regeneration of transgenic plants. Journal of Plant Research. 111: 1104, 565-572. Venkatachalam P, Geetha N, Khandelwal A, Shaila MS, Lakshmisita G (2000) Agrobacterium mediated genetic transformation and regeneration of transgenic plants from cotyledon explants of groundnut (Arachis hypogaea L.) via somatic embryogenesis. Current Science. 78 (9): 1130-1136. 86 87 Journal of Today’s Biological Sciences: Research & Review (JTBSRR) ISSN 2320-1444 (Online) JTBSRR Vol.1, Issue 1, page 87-95, December 30, 2012 Available on: www.jtbsrr.in “Groundnut (Arachis Hypogaea L.) Germplasm Cultivation” R. P. Bansode* and P. R. Shingare *Department of Botany, ASP College, Devrukh- 415804, Ratnagiri, Department of Botany, Dr. Babasaheb Ambedkar Marathwada University, Aurangabad - 431004 (MS) India. *Corresponding author email: drranjitbansode@gmail.com Abstract Ten varieties of groundnut seeds were collected from “Agricultural College Latur (MS) India” were sown in randomized block design. The germination percentage was observed as maximum in LGN-2 and K-411 (98.14%) and minimum in TAG-24(85.18%). Highest numbers of leaves were measured in TKG-19A at 75 days (205) and minimum in TLG-45 at 15days (2). Maximum height was measured in K-411 at 105 days (31.7cm) and minimum in TLG-45 at 15 days (1.0cm). Rhizosphere microflora of these varieties shows difference in colony number of fungi, bacteria and actinomycetes. But the age of groundnut plants are directly proportional to colonies of fungi, bacteria and actinomycetes. The early flowering varieties were observed as K-411, TKG-19A, LGN-1 and TAG-24.The variety K- 411 shows maximum biomass among 10 varieties and Phule Unap give maximum yield. Keywords Arachis hypogaea; ten varieties; comparative study Introduction Groundnut is named as Arachis hypogaea Linn. and belonging to the family Fabaceae. It is native of “Brazil”. The first written account of this crop is found 87 88 with the Spanish entry Hispanlola in 1502 where the “Arawak” cultivated under the name of Mani. Records from the Brazil around 1550 showed the crop was known there with the name “mandubi”. At present groundnut is grown widely in almost all the tropical and sub-tropical countries of the world and also in the warm temperate region for its beneficial fruits used in several ways (Buting A. H. et al.1985). It is cultivated through the India in “Kharif” season from April to July. It grows best in warm region in India where temperature varies between 27 to 30 and annual rainfall is between 50 and125 cm. well drained sandy looms are the most favorable soils for groundnut growing (Ohu J. O. et al. 2006). In India groundnut is grown over 6.4 million hectors with yield of over 6.9 million tons during 2001-2002 .The crop is largely in Andhra Pradesh ,Gujarat ,Tamil Nadu, Karnataka, U. P., M. P., Punjab and Rajasthan (Shankarappa Talawar 2004). Groundnut oil is non-drying vegetable oil cold pressed oil is golden yellow in colour and possesses a faint agreeable smell. Principal fatty acids present in the oil are oleic acids (56%) linolic acid (25%) and palmitic acid (6-12%). A little amount of stearic acid arachidic and higher saturated acid is also present. The oil is rich in phosphorus and vitamins (Thiamine riboflavin and niacin). (Wrenshell, C. L. 1949). It is predominantly used for caulinary purposes. It is extensively used for the manufacture of “vegetable ghee” by hydrogenation .It is also used as lubricant and blends with mineral oil have been developed. Medicinally, the oil is used as a laxative and emollient, soap-making, shaving creams, cold creams pomades, candles, glycerin tallow substitutes. Emulsion is used for control of many insect pests of plants Oil cake is used as feed for cattle and other farm animals and as manure. The residue after uprooting the groundnut plants also useful for cattle as fodder. The best quality cake is grounded into flour for human consumption as a protein-rich food supplement (Singh and Singh 1991). Materials and Methods A) Material used for comparative study of Groundnut Germplasm cultivation The material used for comparative study of groundnut germplasm was of 10different varieties of groundnut. The groundnut germplasm were collected from “Agricultural College Latur”. These varieties were as follows: 1) LGN – 2 2) AK -320 3) TKG -19A 4) PHULE UNAP 5) M – 13 88 89 6) LGN – 1 7) K – 1341 8) K – 411 9) TLG – 45 10) TAG – 24 Out of the total varieties of groundnut, these 10-varieties were selected for the comparative study. B) Following methods were used for experimentation Before sowing, the field was cleared, ploughed 3-4 times, ordinarily no manuring was required. The seeds of these ten varieties were sown. Before sowing the plot were wetted with the help of running water. The sowing was done by hand method in June. The seeds show “epigeal type” of germination that is cotyledons raises along the growth of seedling. The percentage of germination of these varieties was calculated with the help of total seed sown and number of seed germinated. Each variety showed the variation in the leaf count after 15, 30 45… 120 days. The difference in number of leaf was counted from sowing to 15 days interval. Height was also noted after 15 days interval from sowing up to 120 days. After 15 days interval from sowing the microflora of root was observed on the selective media for fungi, bacteria and actinomycetes. The media used for fungi was “Rose Bengal”, for bacteria Thornton’s agar medium and for actinomycetes Jensen’s media. The fungi were observed and identified. Bacterial and actinomycetes colonies were counted and result was tabulated. Three plants of each variety was selected as (small, medium and large.) a sample for calculation of biomass. The fresh weights of such three samples were taken as “fresh weight”. After sun drying, the dry weights of sample have measured as a biomass for each groundnut variety. Firstly, number of pods per plant was measured and then number of grains and weight of grains was calculated. In this way, the total yield per variety was calculated. Results and Discussion Under the observation germination percentage was found maximum in LGN-2 and K-411 (98.14%). While the minimum was reported in TAG-24 (85.18%) (Table 1). The maximum number of leaves was noted after 75 days in variety TKG-19A and minimum in variety TAG-24 after 75 days (Table 2). The height of the plant was measured at the interval of 15 days. Maximum height in K-411 at 105 days (31.7cm) minimum in TAG-24 (10.0cm) (Table 3). Rhizosphere microflora of these varieties shows difference in colony number of fungi, 89 90 bacteria and actinomycetes (Table 4). However, the age of groundnut plants is directly proportional to colonies of fungi, bacteria and actinomycetes (Table 5). Table 1. Percentage of seed germination in groundnut varieties Sr. No. Name varieties 1 2 3 4 LGN-2 AK-320 TKG-19A PHULE UNAP M-13 LGN-1 K-1341 K-411 TLG-45 54 54 54 54 Number of Percentage of seed germination germinate 53 98.14 49 90.74 52 96.29 48 88.89 54 54 54 54 54 48 49 47 53 51 88.89 90.74 87.03 98.14 94.44 TAG-24 54 46 85.18 5 6 7 8 9 10 of Total Seed Table 2. Number of Leaves from sowing to 15 days intervals Sr. No. 1 Name of 15 Varieties Days LGN-2 8 30 Days 23 45 Days 72 60 Days 68 75 Days 99 90 Days 102 105 Days 47 120 Days 35 2 3 AK-320 TKG19A PHULE UNAP M-13 LGN-1 K-1341 K-411 TLG-45 TAG-24 7 7 17 13 53 67 53 142 99 205 78 201 27 76 25 75 7 21 52 100 109 100 25 74 5 5 7 13 2 7 32 19 25 32 17 20 66 50 59 180 34 36 73 67 61 198 71 54 105 85 99 200 72 56 106 74 80 119 27 23 75 26 26 68 12 72 35 35 38 - 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 90 91 Table 3. Height of groundnut varieties (cm) from sowing to 15 days intervals Sr. No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Name of Varieties LGN-2 AK-320 TKG-19A PHULE UNAP M-13 LGN-1 K-1341 K-411 TLG-45 TAG-24 15 Days 8 7 7 7 30 Days 23 17 13 21 45 Days 72 53 67 52 60 Days 68 53 142 100 75 Days 99 99 205 109 90 Days 102 78 201 100 105 Days 47 27 76 25 120 Days 35 25 75 74 5 5 7 13 2 7 32 19 25 32 17 20 66 50 59 180 34 36 73 67 61 198 71 54 105 85 99 200 72 56 106 74 80 119 27 23 75 26 26 68 12 72 35 35 38 - Table 4. Rhizosphere study of groundnut from sowing to 15 days intervals Sr. No. Days 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 15 Days 30 Days 45 Days 60 Days 75 Days 90 Days 105 Days 120 Days Number of Colonies Fungi Bacteria 37 892 47 1133 54 1176 58 1187 68 1308 65 1370 69 1448 78 1485 Actinomycetes 87 105 114 115 208 285 402 447 Table No. 5 Identified Fungi from Rhizosphere of groundnut Fungi Aspergillus sp. Penicillium sp. Rhizopus sp. Fusarium sp. Trichoderma sp. Macrophamina sp. Regarding the flowering time the comparative study was made, it was found that TKG-19A, LGN-1, K-411, TAG-24 were early flowering varieties of groundnut; the flowers were appeared at 52 days. Biomass of the varieties was measured by taking the difference between fresh weight and dry weight and it was found that TKG-19A have shown maximum biomass (Table 6). It was 91 92 recorded variety wise as follows by taking the No. of pods and grain weight. Variety PHULE UNAP has shown high yield (5.93gm) (Table 7). Groundnut thrives best in well - drained sandy loam soil, as light soils helps in easy penetration of pegs and their development and their harvesting. However, soils in plots are cotton black soil and having high water holding capacity. Table 6. Biomass of ten varieties of groundnut Sr. no. 1) 2) 3) 4) 5) 6) 7) 8) 9) 10) Name of variety LGN – 2 AK -320 TKG – 19A PHULE UNAP M - 13 LGN – 1 K-1341 K- 411 TLG-45 TAG -24 Fresh weight / Dry weight 11.66gm 21.67gm 46.67gm 11.66gm 13.0gm 7.33gm 9.67gm 23.0gm - Table 7. Yield of ten varieties of groundnut Sr. No. Name of variety No. of pods (weight) 1 LGN-2 30(13.36gm) 2 AK-320 20(7.78gm) 3 TKG-19A 10(8.32gm) 4 PHULE UNAP 2817.78gm) 5 M-13 11(13.33gm) 6 LGN-1 17(15.67gm) 7 K-1341 16(10.03gm 8 K-411 21(14.2gm) Grain weight 4.45 gm 2.49gm 2.77gm 5.93gm 4.44gm 5.22gm 3.34gm 4.74gm Rhizosphere microflora also affected on growth on development on groundnut plant it is due to the contact of microorganism with roots, rich microflora can be also promotes the groundnut plants (Louice M. Nelson 2002 and Sarode P. P. et al. 2007). It is due to the nitrogen fixing bacteria in nodules provides nitrogen in the form of nitrate and nitrites. Mycorhiza like Trichodrma spp. also act as anti aflatoxin again some harmful fungi present in the groundnut growing soil (Louice M. Nelson 2002). The early flowering varieties of groundnut escape from groundnut pathogenic effect (Somewhat less extent). Due to the early flowering and attain early maturity. These varieties are TKG-19A, LGN-1, K-411 and TAG-24.The variety K411 shows maximum biomass and Phule Unap give maximum yield. (5.93gm / plant). 92 93 Acknowledgements Authors are thankful to Prof. V. S. Kothekar, Head, Department of Botany, Dr. Babasaheb Ambedkar Marathwada University, Aurangabad, for providing all the necessary facilities and encouragement. Anthesis in early flowering varieties of Arachis hypogaea Linn. A B C D Plate: A, B, C and D are Fungi associated with Groundnut varieties. 93 94 References Buting, A. H. Gibbons, R.W. and Wynne, J.C., 1985. Groundnut (Arachis Hypogaea L). World geography of peanut. Mamman, J. O. and Muni, U. B., 2006. Influence of vehicular tropic on air permeability and groundnut production in asemi-arid loam soil. International Agrophysiscs, 20:309-315. Karajikat, P. N., Jadhav, G. S., and Wakle, P. K., 2004. Ecophysiology of yield expression in groundnut genotype during post monsoon season. Journal of oilseed research 21:39-41. Louice M. Nelson, 2002. Plant growth promoting Rhizobacteria prospect for new inoculants. Plant Management Network. Nwokolo, E. and Smortt, J., 1996. Food and free from Legumes and oil seeds. Chapman and Hall New York, pp 49-63. Patel, L. R., Patel, R.H., Patel, J. K., 1991. Response of groundnut varieties of different dates of sowing and row spacing. Journal of oil seed research 8:263-266. Pathi, A. K., 1994. Response of groundnut varieties to time sowing under rainfied conditions. Journal of oilseeds research 11:132-133. Sahu, D. D. and Ptoliya, B. M., 2005. Assessment of efficient groundnut cropping zone in Gujarat, India. International Arachis Newsletter 25:48-51. Sarode, P. P., Rane, M. P., Chaudhari, B. L. and Chincholkar, S. B., 2007. Screening for siderophore producing PGPR from black cotton soils of North Maharashtra. Current trends in Biotechnology Pharmacy. Vol. 1. (1) 96-105. Satish Kumar, G. D. and Popat, M. N., 2007. Knowledge and adaptation of aflatoxin management practices in groundnut forming in Junagad, Gujarat, India. E- journal by ICRISAT volume 3. Shankarappa Talawar, 2004. Peanut in India, history, production and utilization of peanut in local and global food system report no. 5(pp 3:4). Singh, B. and Singh, U., 1991. Peanut as a source of protein for human food. Plant food for human nutrition 41: 165-177. 94 95 Weiss, E. A., 2000. Oilseed crops. Black well science London. Wrenshell, C. L. 1949. American Peanut industry. Economic Botany, 3:159-169. 95 96 Journal of Today’s Biological Sciences: Research & Review (JTBSRR) ISSN 2320-1444 (Online) JTBSRR Vol.1, Issue 1, page 96-100, December 30, 2012 Available on: www.jtbsrr.in Effect of Fungicides and Biocontrol Agents in the Management of Sugarcane Smut Disease B. Meena* and SA. Ramyabharathi Department of Plant Pathology, Tamil Nadu Agricultural University, Coimbatore,TamilNadu,India,Email:meepath@rediffmail.com *Corresponding author Abstract Smut disease caused by Ustilago scitaminea is a dreadful disease of sugarcane and is endemic in most of the tropical regions. Results are described of field trials in which attempts were made to control sugarcane smut with fungicides and biocontrol agents. Smut disease of sugarcane was successfully controlled in the plant crop when seed cane was treated with the solution of fungicide, Triademefon. The lowest smut infection (4.4%) and the highest yield of 153 t/ha was recorded in the sett treatment and foliar spray of Triadimefon 0.1% at 30, 45 and 60 DAP. The highest smut infection of 20.0% and the lowest yield of 113 t/ha was observed in the control. Key words: Fungicides, biocontrol agents, smut, sugarcane Introduction Sugarcane is not only cash crop for the growers, but it is main source of white crystal sugar. Sugarcane smut caused by the fungus Ustilago scitanninea Sydow is becoming a more important problem in many cane growing areas of the world. The disease is referred to as `culmicolous' smut of sugarcane because it affects the stalk of the cane. Smut may remain unnoticed for years, then quickly devastate large areas of susceptible varieties. Hence, the disease has been called the `dread 96 97 disease of sugarcane' by some and a `trivial disease with exaggerated yield losses' by others. Infection ranges from 30-40% in plant crops and even up to 70% in ratoons. Sucrose content of infected cane is reduced to 3-7%. The smut pathogen usually infects the cane plant through the buds (Bock, 1964) and the infection of the buds of seed cane at or shortly after planting is likely to be an important factor in the development of epidemics. The affected canes produce long, black whip-like and coiled or curved shoots, which are covered with a thin silvery membrane, containing masses of chlamydospores of the fungus. Later on that membrane ruptures and releases a multitude of spores, which contaminate soil and the standing crop. Whips begin emerging from infected cane by 2-4 months of age with peak whip growth occurring at the 6th or 7th month. The diseased plants are unfit for use. Primary spread of the disease is through infected setts and the secondary spread is through wind borne teliospores. Spores of sugarcane smut, U. scitaminea are dilute brown, smooth and 5.5 to 7.5 u in dia. The period from infection to whip production is about 6 months under field conditions (Waller, 1969). Application to seed cane at the time of planting is also likely to be the simplest and cheapest method by which chemicals could be used for disease control in sugarcane. Little work has been reported on the testing of fungicides applied to healthy or diseased setts that have been planted in the field under severely smutcontaminated conditions. Materials and methods Field experiment was conducted during 2010-2011 for managing smut disease of sugarcane using systemic fungicides and biocontrol agents. The smut whips were collected from infected clumps and from these a suspension of teliospores was prepared with water. Sugarcane setts were dipped for five minutes in this spore suspension (10 6 spores/ml). Then the setts were treated with respective fungicides and other microbial treatments for 15 minutes before planting. The variety Co-Si (SC) 6 was used for the field experiment. Observations were made on germination percentage, number of tillers per hectare, smut disease incidence and cane yield (t/ha). The percentage of smut infection was recorded at monthly intervals. Results and Discussion The results presented in Table 1 revealed that germination percentage varied from 71.3 to 82.0% among the treatments. The number of tillers per hectare 97 98 varied from 68,000 to 92,000 in the various treatments. The plant height ranged from 7.3 to 9.6 m among the treatments (Table 1). Sett treatment and foliar spray with Triademefon at a concentration of 0.1% effectively reduced smut infection which recorded smut disease incidence of 4.4%. This was followed by sett treatment and foliar spray with Propiconazole 0.1% which showed disease incidence of 5.0%. The biocontrol agents were not effective in reducing the smut infection which recorded disease incidence of 8.1%. In the control, maximum disease incidence of 20% was observed (Table 2). The yield was also found to be the highest (153 t/ha) in the effective treatment of sett treatment and foliar application of Triadimefon 0.1%; whereas in the control, the lowest yield of 113 t/ha was recorded (Table 1). Table 1. Effect of fungicides and biocontrol agents on plant growth and yield parameters of sugarcane Treatments Germina tion (%) Number of Plant tillers/ha height (m) Cane yield (t/ha) Sett treatment + Foliar Spray with carbendazim 0.1 % at 30, 45 and 60 DAP Sett treatment + Foliar Spray with Triadimefon 0.1% at 30, 45 and 60 DAP Sett treatment + Foliar Spray with Propiconazole 0.1% at 30, 45 and 60 DAP Sett treatment + Foliar Spray with Copper hydroxide 0.1% at 30, 45 and 60 DAP Sett treatment + Foliar Spray with Chlorothalonil 0.1% at 30, 45 and 60 DAP 82.0 86,000 9.6 129 78.0 82,000 8.9 153 77.5 86,000 8.7 145 76.0 72,000 9.2 136 79.0 92,000 9.4 138 Sett treatment + Foliar Spray with Kresoxinmethyl 40% + Hexaconazole 8% (0.1%) at 30, 45 and 60 DAP Sett treatment with Pseudomonas fluorescens @ 20 g /litre + Foliar Spray with P. fluorescens 0.1% at 30, 45 and 60 DAP Sett treatment with microbial consortia (Trichoderma viride + P. fluorescens + Bacillus subtilis) each @ 10 g/litre + Foliar Spray with microbial consortia 0.1% at 30, 45 and 60 DAP Control 80.0 88,000 8.9 145 78.8 92,000 9.4 124 77.5 88,000 9.2 126 71.3 68,000 7.3 113 7.2 12740 0.9 6.4 CD (P=0.05) Mean of three replications A successful fungicide treatment that aided in the production of healthy seed cane and that protected seed cane from infection at planting could make a useful contribution to the control of smut. Investigations of the use 98 99 of fungicides for the control of smut have been carried out with setts that were inoculated by dipping in spore suspensions, either before or after treatment with fungicides (Muthusamy, 1973; James, 1976; Atienza and Reyes (1977). Bharathi (2010) reported that sett treatment with fungicides had shown radical reduction in smut incidence and fungicidal sett treatment did not exhibit any influence on germination and shoot production. Table 2. Management sugarcane smut disease using fungicides and biocontrol agents Treatments Nov 2010 Smut disease incidence Dec Jan Feb 2010 2011 2011 March 2011 Sett treatment + Foliar Spray with carbendazim 0.1 % at 30, 45 and 60 DAP Sett treatment + Foliar Spray with Triadimefon 0.1% at 30, 45 and 60 DAP Sett treatment + Foliar Spray with Propiconazole 0.1% at 30, 45 and 60 DAP Sett treatment + Foliar Spray with Copper hydroxide 0.1% at 30, 45 and 60 DAP Sett treatment + Foliar Spray with Chlorothalonil 0.1% at 30, 45 and 60 DAP 1.8 3.8 4.4 4.4 7.5 0.6 1.3 1.3 1.3 4.4 1.3 1.3 1.3 2.5 5.0 1.8 3.1 3.8 4.4 6.9 1.8 3.1 3.8 4.4 6.9 Sett treatment + Foliar Spray with Kresoxinmethyl 40% + Hexaconazole 8% (0.1%) at 30, 45 and 60 DAP Sett treatment with Pseudomonas fluorescens @ 20 g /litre + Foliar Spray with P. fluorescens 0.1% at 30, 45 and 60 DAP Sett treatment with microbial consortia (Trichoderma viride + P. fluorescens + Bacillus subtilis) each @ 10 g/litre + Foliar Spray with microbial consortia 0.1% at 30, 45 and 60 DAP Control 1.3 2.5 2.5 3.1 5.6 2.5 4.4 4.a 5.6 8.1 2.5 4.4 4.4 5.0 8.1 3.1 5.6 6.9 8.1 20.0 1.9 1.9 2.4 2.5 3.1 CD (P=0.05) Mean of three replications Triadimefon applied to seed cane in the hot water tank consistently provided complete or excellent protection against smut in the plant cane crops (Bailey, 1979). This treatment was effective for infected seed cane that was inoculated or planted in soil containing smut spores. The treatment, therefore, is both eradicative and protective in action. 99 100 References Atienza, C.S. and Reyes, L.G. 1977. Control of sugarcane smut with pyracarbolid fungicides. Philsutech Proc., 25: 33-36. Bailey, R.A. 1979. Possibilities for the control of sugarcane smut (Ustilago scitaminea) with fungicides. Proceedings of The South African Sugar Technologist's Association, 137-142. Bharathi, V. 2010. Chemical control of sugarcane smut through sett treatment with fungicides. Int. J. Pl. Protect., 2: 151-153. Bock, K.R. 1964. Studies on sugarcane smut (Ustilago scitaminea) in Kenya. Trans. Br. Mycol. Soc., 47: 403-417. James, G.L. 1976. Preplant fungicidal dips : A long term measure against smut. Sug. Path. News, 17: 4-5. Muthusamy, S. 1973. Fungicides in the control of sugarcane smut. Sug. Path. News, 10: 11 – 13. Waller, J.M. 1969. Sugarcane smut (Ustilago scitaminea) in Kenya : I. Epidemiology. Transactions of the British Mycological Society, 52: 139-151. 100 101 Journal of Today’s Biological Sciences: Research & Review (JTBSRR) ISSN 2320-1444 (Online) JTBSRR Vol.1, Issue 1, page 101-121, December 30, 2012 Available on: www.jtbsrr.in Seasonal Movements and Migration of Birds: Indian Scenario Swati Bopinwar1, S.B. Zade1, T.K. Ghosh2* 1P. G. Department of Zoology, R.T.M. Nagpur University,Campus, Nagpur– 440033(M.S.). 2Ultratech Environmental Consultancy and Laboratory, Survey no. 87, office 7 and 8, Bandal Prestige (in front of Siddhi Vinayak Mandir), Azad Nagar, Kothrud, Pune-411 038, E. mail- tkghosh@ultratech.in Abstract The exploration of bird-migration has entered a new era with individual-based tracking during multiple years. Attempt has been made to collate available information pertaining to migratory patterns of long-distance migrating birds to India in order to analyse the variations amongst different species. While annual timings of migration vary much less between repeated journeys of the same individual as compared to different individuals, there are considerable variations in the routes of different varieties of birds within India. The necessity of bird’s migration, threats encountered and conservation practices have been critically assessed. Key words: Bird migration, routes in India, flyways, diurnal & nocturnal migrants, threats, conservation Introduction Migration is the regular, seasonal movement of populations from one geographic location to another, and is common among most varieties of birds. It is marked by the eventual return to the original place of departure and is most evident among certain bird species that usually follow a yearly cycle. Donald (1952) studied migration of birds across the Himalaya, and Ali (1962) on Wagtails in 101 102 Kerala. In between 1963 and 1969, Biswas studied bird migration in southern West Bengal with a view to collect data regarding the pattern of migration, period of stay in the wintering area, time taken for journey etc. (ZSI 1991).While George (1964) studied the same in Bihar, Mathew (1971) reviewed the recovery data obtained by the BNHS’s bird migration study project. Khacher (1978) studied bird migration across the Himalaya. Rainfall has great influence on the bird population (Bayliss 1989). Birds migrate for many reasons that include the need to travel to areas where food resources are at their peak abundance. The food of the birds varies and is different not only in respect of different birds, but also in respect of different seasons. The adaptive value of migration with fluctuating food sources has earlier been well documented (Lack 1968; Alerstam et al. 2003). Survival challenges encountered on these journeys may be responsible for a majority of annual adult mortality in land birds (Sillett and Holmes 2002). Newton (2008) reported that there was increased mortality during long migrations of avifauna. Why do birds migrate? Birds migrate for many reasons that include the need to travel to areas where food resources are at their peak abundance, the climate is milder and there is less competition for safe nesting places. However, the main environmental trigger for bird migration seems to be the changing ratio of daylight and darkness. With the onset of winter, days get shorter reducing activity hours. This triggers the almost entirely instinctive phenomenon of bird migration. Migration has considerable ecological significance. It enables birds to exploit peaks of food production and to settle in areas where they could otherwise not live. Timing of migration Timing of migration is a mix of internal stimulus which results in a feeding binge to put on fat to feel that they have put on enough fat to provide them energy throughout the journey and then the tendency to aggregate into flocks. Once the pre-migration flock is gathered, the feeding continues while the birds wait for suitable weather conditions. Thus, while the birds' internal clock probably releases the hormonal triggers at a fairly accurate date each year, the availability of food and the presiding weather conditions decide when the migration starts and hence when the first spring migrants arrive and the last autumn ones leave. 102 103 Migration may be either during the day or night. Larger birds generally migrate by day and smaller ones by night. Birds of prey, swallows and crows migrate by day. Wildfowl, pelicans, storks, swifts etc are diurnal migrants. Nocturnal migrants include water-birds, cuckoo, flycatchers, thrushes, warblers, orioles, buntings, most songbirds etc. It is believed to be some hormonal stimulus to migrate, resulting, at least in the spring, in the development of the gonads. Other stimuli appear to involve temperature, daylight/darkness ratios and an internal clock. The timing of migration is usually a mixture of internal and external stimulus. Types of migration Birds generally migrate in flocks. Most migrations are latitudinal, i.e. from North to South; also some migrate from East to West. It is used to describe movements of bird populations. One way to look at migration is to consider the distances travelled. Short-distance migrants: May move only a short distance, as from higher to lower elevations on a mountainside. Medium-distance migrants: Some species may cover distances that span from one to several states. Long-distance migrants: Birds that typically have ranges that extend from one continent in the summer to another in the winter. The pattern of migration can vary within each category, but is most variable in short and medium distance migrants. The long-distance migrants are mainly insect-eaters and waders, which follow set migration patterns. Seed-eaters, on the other hand, have more random movements, while fruit-eating birds are generally resident (http://birding.krugerpark.co.za/birding-in-kruger-migrationroutes.html). How does the weather affect migration? Weather is the number one driving factor for migration. Bird’s sensitivity varies towards temperature and other environmental conditions. There is indication that a following wind is of major importance. A clear sky also helps, but is of secondary importance. Birds will take flight in overcast days if the wind is good. For hawks and other soaring birds, updrafts are of extreme 103 104 importance. They can't go very far flapping those heavy, wind-resistant wings. That's why they usually fly parallel to north-south mountain ridges that will produce updrafts with the wind. They gain altitude in one updraft and glide towards the next one. That's how some raptors will migrate all the way to Argentina and back. Birds also try to avoid storms and foggy weather whenever possible. Every year thousands of birds die on severe storms, disoriented or exhausted, many get lost at sea. To avoid this, northern migration of great ocean crossers American Golden-Plovers is made inland, following the rivers in the Amazon Basin and the Mississippi valley. This is much safer than doing the North Atlantic Ocean cross again, as the weather there is still in the grip of winter and there's nowhere to land. Migration can be acquired, abandoned or pro­longed by a species, depending on conditions along their migratory routes (Able and Beltoff 1998). According to BBC news South East Wales (July 12, 2012) unpredictable weather had altered bird migration patterns, with many arriving in Wales weeks earlier than expected. The report further commented “2012 has been a year of unpredictable weather, and many birds have already been affected”. Sudden changes in the weather can be disastrous for birds. Many birds prefer to fly at a higher altitude while migrating. This is because winds usually prevail at higher altitudes and at the same time, the cold temperature at these altitudes helps them in diffusing the body heat, which is generated by their flight muscles. Flyways Global The first natural historian to write about migration as an observable fact was Aristotle. Though Herodotus described the migration of Cranes from north of the Black Sea to Central Africa 100 years before, Aristotle was an astute observer and as well as recording the times of departure of some species from Greece, and listing Pelicans, Turtle Doves, Swallows, Quail, Swans and Geese correctly as migrants. He accurately observed that all migrating birds fatten themselves up before migrating. Birds that migrate from the same geographic region often follow broadly well-defined routes known as migratory flyways. There are eight recognized shorebird flyways around the world (http://www.kolkatabirds.com/migration.htm). The Asia-Pacific region, as defined by the main migratory routes of water birds, is made up of three shorebird flyways the Central Asian Flyway, the East Asian-Australasian Flyway and the Western (or Central) Pacific Flyway crossing 57 countries and territories in the region. The East Asian-Australasian Flyway is the best studied and stretches from Siberia and Alaska southwards through East and SE Asia to Australia and New Zealand, and supports over five million migratory shorebirds. The Central Asian flyway spans about 30 countries from the Arctic to the Indian ocean. But these flyways 104 105 are just generalizations and bird populations have been known not to strictly follow it. During migration, birds depend on strategically located staging areas where they stop to rest and "refuel", by building up fat deposits, before continuing their migration. Indian In India and South Asia, out of over 2000 species and sub-species, about 350 are migrants. It is estimated that over 100 species of migratory birds fly into India, either in search of food or to escape severe winter of their native habitat. In Indian subcontinent, the majority of migratory birds are winter migrants. When the conditions at their natural habitat become unfavorable due to low temperatures, migratory birds fly to regions where conditions are comparatively favorable. However, the physiology and mechanics of migratory bird flights are not very well known in India. The Bombay Natural History Society (BNHS), Mumbai has been working since 1926 to rectify this shortcoming. Migratory routes are not fixed and in some species part of the population follows one route and parts another. In India, the winter migrants from central Asia and Siberia are thought to use two main flyways; one in the west along the Indus valley and the other in the NE along the river Brahmaputra. Some migrants fly very long distances. The majority of the avian migrants to India are from the north and beyond the temperate latitudes. These come from Asia Minor, Arabia, Central & NE Asia, East Asia and Europe. First year birds may migrate unescorted to a winter home they have never before seen and return the following spring to the area in which they were born. Arrival of migratory birds in India Avian migration is a natural process, whereby different birds fly over distances of hundreds and thousands of kilometers in order to find the best ecological conditions and habitats for feeding, breeding and raising their young. During December several birds from the colder regions are spotted at several places in India. Depending on species and country of origin, there are different migration patterns. While small birds like flycatchers arrive in early November, wagtails usually arrive in mid-October. Ducks turn up by end of October or early November in huge numbers. It has been observed that extended rainfall, beyond monsoon, delayed arrival of birds who find difficult to fly in the rain. The bird’s migration has been categorized into winter migrants, summer migrants, and passage migrants. Birds visiting the lake between November and February are 105 106 the winter visitors. Some residential and migratory birds breed or remain in the lake in summer and are called summer visitors. A brief account of the migratory birds in India is summarized in Table 1. Presently, probably due to the climate change, departure dates of many of the migratory species are postponed and this has an alarming significance because food cycles and arrival times of migrants in the tropics become synchronized. Almost 80 per cent of migratory birds did not turn up in 2010. At least 15-16 varieties of ducks arrive every year but in 2010 there were hardly any despite of abundance of water. The only species present in the year were the northern shoveller, a few wigeons, the brahminy shelduck and pintails. Species abundance and diversity both have reduced. Waders (longlegged wading birds), little-ringed plovers and others like the kentish plovers, greenshank and redshank were only a few in 2010. Birds of prey, such as the montagu harrier, pale harrier, hen harrier and the pied harrier that usually come from Eastern Europe, Central, Northern Asia and Southeast Asia did not arrive in 2010. The biggest change has been observed in the migratory patterns of water birds. Due to changing crop pattern, the number of cranes coming to India over the years has reduced by as much as 75 per cent. As many as 4,000-5,000 barheaded geese were sighted in the past. But in the last two years, flocks of only 4050 of these birds were seen at one time. The number of geese has definitely reduced by 50 per cent (Agarwal, 2011). Table 1. Distribution of migratory birds in India Sr. Common No Name . Ashy 1 Minivet Scientific name Type of migration Pericrocotus divaricatus Vagrant Distribution in India C Peninsula, Mumbai, Andaman Himalayas, C India, E Ghats, Resident & widespread W Ghats, Peninsula, winter visitor Andaman, Nicobar, Meghalaya, Ladakh 2 Asian Brown Flycatcher Muscicapa dauurica 3 Barheaded Goose Anser indicus Widespread winter visitor Ladakh, Assam valley, & resident Assam hills, Kashmir 4 Barn Swallow Hirundo rustica Widespread resident winter visitor 5 Black Phoenicurus S Arunachal, S Assam hills, & Lakshadweep, Andaman, Nicobar, Assam valley, Kolkata, Manipur Resident & widespread S Assam hills 106 107 Redstart ochruros winter visitor NW India, Assam valley, Gujarat, Delhi NW Himalayas, Kashmir, S Assam hills (E Meghalaya, Cachar, Manipur) 6 Black Stork Ciconia nigra Widespread winter visitor 7 Blackeared Kite Milvus lineatus Widespread winter visitor Grus nigricollis Winter visitor, breeds in Ladakh, Kashmir, W Bengal, Ladakh Arunachal Podiceps nigricollis Sparse winter visitor Himantopus himantopus Resident & widespread Kashmir, Mumbai, winter visitor Andhra, Himalayas Monticola solitarius Resident & widespread Himalayas winter visitor Ladakh, saline lakes ( Punjab Widespread winter visitor salt range, Sambhar Lake; & resident Rajasthan, salt Lakes near Kolkata), W India 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 Blacknecked Crane Blacknecked Grebe Blackwinged Stilt Blue Rockthrush Brownheaded Gull Caspian Gull Caspian Plover Caspian Tern Cattle Egret Larus brunnicephalus Larus cachinnans Charadrius asiaticus Sparse winter visitor NW India Vagrant W & SE coast of India Sterna caspia Widespread winter visitor Gujarat, NW India Bubulcus ibis Widespread resident Amroha, Uttar Pradesh Buteo buteo Widespread winter visitor Kashmir, Uttar Pradesh & resident 17 Common Buzzard 18 Common Crane Grus grus 19 Common Kestrel Falco tinnunculus 20 21 Common Nightingal e Common Pochard Gujarat,W Gangetic plain, E Assam valley Delhi, NW India (Rajasthan, Gujarat), Common winter visitor Kashmir, Gangetic plain, Assam valley Himalayas (Chitral Himachal, Widespread winter visitor Kashmir), Lakshadweep, S & resident Assam hills Luscinia megarhynchos Vagrant Uttaranchal Aythya ferina Widespread winter visitor N Plains to Assam valley, Ladakh, 107 108 22 Common Quail Coturnix coturnix 23 Common Redshank Tringa totanus 24 Common Ringed Plover Charadrius hiaticula 25 Common Rosefinch 26 Common Sandpiper 27 Common Shelduck 28 Common Stonechat 29 Common Teal 30 31 32 33 Common WoodPigeon Dusky Thrush Eastern Marsh Harrier Eurasian Coot Kashmir, NW India, C India & (Bheraghat), S Gujarat, Gangetic plains, S Mumbai, Cachar, S Maharastra Himalayas (Ladakh) Widespread winter visitor Lakshadweep, S Andaman, & resident Nicobars Widespread resident winter visitor Vagrant SE India, NW India Kashmir, Himalayas, Pune (N Carpodacus Resident & widespread Maharashtra), Nagpur, Assam, erythrinus winter visitor Ladakh, Arunachal, S India, S Assam hills Himalayas to Assam valley, S Tringa Widespread winter visitor Assam hills hypoleucos & resident ( Manipur & Lushai hills), Garhwal, Uttaranchal N plains to Assam valley, Tadorna tadorna Native (Migrant) Chilika Lake (Orissa), N Maharashtra Himalayas to Arunachal, S Saxicola Resident & widespread Assam hills (Assam & torquatus winter visitor Nagaland), S Andaman Himalayas, Assam valley, Anas crecca Widespread winter visitor Kashmir, Lakshadweep, Andaman Columba palumbus Sparse winter visitor Himalayas Bengal Turdus naumanni Sparse winter visitor Khasi hills (E Meghalaya) Circus spilonotus Sparse winter visitor NE India Fulica atra 34 Eurasian Hoopoe Upupa epops 35 Eurasian Otus scops of Kashmir, W Resident & widespread Kashmir, Gujarat, Peninsula, winter visitor Kerala, S Assam hills W Himalayas, Kashmir, Widespread resident & Gangetic plain to Assam winter visitor valley, Peninsula, Lakshadweep, S Andaman Winter visitor W India, Maharashtra 108 109 Scops-Owl 36 37 Eurasian Sparrow hawk Eurasian Spoonbill (Mumbai, Pradesh Accipiter nisus Platalea leucorodia 38 Eurasian Woodcock Scolopax rusticola 39 European Nightjar Caprimulgus europaeus 40 European Roller Coracias garrulus 41 Glossy Ibis Plegadis falcinellus 42 Great Cormorant Phalacrocorax carbo Great Egret Greater Flamingo Greater Spotted Eagle Casmerodius albus Phoenicopterus ruber 43 44 Pune), W Uttar Widespread winter visitor Arunachal, S Assam hills, W & & resident E Ghats, S Andaman Widespread winter visitor N India to Assam, S India & resident Arunachal, S Assam hills Widespread winter visitor ( Meghalaya), W & E Ghats, & resident Karnataka, S India W India (Kutch, Jodhpur), Sparse summer visitor Mumbai, Garhwal, Uttaranchal Kashmir, NW India, Gujarat, C Resident & sparse winter & W Peninsula, Andhra visitor Pradesh Widespread winter visitor S India & resident Saurashtra (Gujarat), Gangetic Widespread winter visitor plains, Punjab to Assam & resident valley, C India, S India Widespread resident & Himalayas to Assam valley, S sparse winter visitor Andaman Widespread winter visitor S Gujarat (Great Runn of & resident Kutch) Aquila clanga Widespread winter visitor N plains to W Assam, C India & resident 46 Grey Heron Ardea cinerea NW & NE India, Kashmir, Widespread winter visitor Lakshadweep, Andaman, & resident Nicobars 47 Grey Wagtail Motacilla cinerea Resident & widespread S Andaman, Nicobars winter visitor 48 Greybacked Shrike Lanius tephronotus Himalayas, Ladakh to Resident & widespread Arunachal, S Assam hills winter visitor (Khasi hills & Manipur), Kolkata 49 Grey- Vanellus Widespread winter visitor 45 109 Eastern plains, Bihar, Assam, S 110 headed Lapwing 50 Indian PondHeron cinereus Ardeola grayii 51 Indian Skimmer Rynchops albicollis 52 Japanese Quail Coturnix japonica 53 Japanese Sparrow hawk Accipiter gularis 54 Lesser Flamingo Phoenicopterus minor 55 Little Ringed Plover Charadrius dubius 56 Little Tern Sterna albifrons 57 Longbilled Plover Charadrius placidus 58 Northern Harrier 59 Northern Shrike Assam hills (Cachar, Manipur), SW Bengal (Kolkata), Orissa, Delhi, Bharatpur, Kashmir, N & S Gujarat Widespread resident Assam valley, S Assam hills, Lakshadweep, Andaman NW India, Rajasthan to Madhya Pradesh, W Bihar, SE Madhya Pradesh, EC Andhra Widespread resident Pradesh, N Maharashtra (Dhule), SW Gujarat, NW coast, W Assam Bihar, Assam (Dibrugarh), Sparse winter visitor Manipur valley S Andaman, Andhra Pradesh, Dibrugarh (E Assam), Sparse winter visitor Nicobars, Mhow (Madhya Pradesh) S Gujarat (Great Runn of Common winter visitor, Kutch), Rajasthan (Sambhar some resident Lake) Punjab, S Kashmir, S Jammu, Himalayas to Assam valley, S Widespread winter visitor Assam hills ( Manipur valley, & resident Cachar), Kolkata, Andaman, Ganges valley, Delhi to Assam Uttan Washi (Mumbai), C Widespread resident India, Lakshadweep, East coast of India, S Andaman Sparse winter visitor N Uttar Pradesh to Assam valley, Manipur, Delhi Circus cyaneus Widespread winter visitor Himalayas to Assam valley, S Assam hills ( E Meghalaya, Cachar), S Gangetic plains Lanius excubitor Widespread resident Kashmir 110 111 60 Oriental Honeybuzzard Pernis ptilorhyncus Widespread winter visitor & resident 61 Osprey Pandion haliaetus Widespread winter visitor & resident Painted Stork Pied Avocet Mycteria leucocephala Recurvirostra avosetta Pied Harrier Circus melanoleucos Widespread winter visitor & resident Ardea purpurea Widespread winter visitor & resident S Assam hills (E Meghalaya, N Cachar, S Nagaland, Manipur), Andaman, Ladakh, Mhow & Bhundara (Madhya Pradesh), Nander ( N Andhra Pradesh), Patna (Bihar), Mangpu (W Bengal), Charduar (Assam) S Assam hills, Lakshadweep, Andaman, Nicobars, W Himalayas Gangetic plains, Gujarat to Punjab, NE & S Peninsula Kutch (S Gujarat), N India, W coast of India, Assam, Kashmir Plains of Uttar Pradesh to Assam valley, S Assam hills (Cachar, Meghalaya, Manipur), S India, W & NE India NW India, Andaman, C Nicobars, N Andhra Pradesh Lanius collurio Sparse passage migrant NW India, S Gujarat 62 63 64 65 66 Purple Heron Redbacked Shrike Widespread resident Widespread winter visitor & resident Lakshadweep, Kashmir, & Himalayas from Murree hills to Arunachal, Andaman, Nicobar Assam valley, NE Ghats, W Resident & sparse winter Khandesh (Maharashtra), S visitor Assam hills, W Himalayas Widespread winter visitor NW & S India, W Bengal, & migrant Andaman Ladakh, Sub-Himalayan plains of N India, S Assam hills Winter visitor (Khasi hills, Cachar, E Meghalaya, Manipur) Keoladeo Ghana WLS Rare winter visitor (Bharatpur), N India, Bihar, Ladakh 67 Redrumped Swallow Widespread resident Hirundo daurica winter visitor 68 Rosy Minivet Pericrocotus roseus 69 Rosy Starling Sturnus roseus 70 Shorteared Owl Asio flammeus 71 Siberian Crane Grus leucogeranus 72 Spoonbill Eurynorhynchu s pygmeus Sparse winter visitor 111 W Bengal, Kerala, Tamil Nadu 112 Sandpiper 73 74 75 76 77 Spot-billed Duck Sykes's Nightjar White Stork White Wagtail Whiteeyed Buzzard (Point Calimere), Orissa (Chilika Lake), Kolkata, Assam valley Anas poecilorhyncha Caprimulgus mahrattensis Ciconia ciconia Motacilla alba Butastur teesa Widespread resident S Assam hills W India, Delhi, N Madhya Pradesh, Mumbai Gangetic plains, Gujarat, NW Widespread winter visitor India Resident & widespread Arunachal, Andaman, winter visitor Lakshadweep, S Assam hills Winter visitor Widespread resident 78 Wood Sandpiper Tringa glareola Widespread winter visitor 79 Yellow Wagtail Motacilla flava Widespread winter visitor 80 Yellowrumped Flycatcher Ficedula zanthopygia Vagrant NW Himalayas to Himachal, W Bengal, S Assam hills Himalayas to Assam valley, S Assam hills (Meghalaya, Cachar), S Andaman, Lakshadweep, W & NW India N Punjab, Garo hills (W Meghalaya), NW India, Andaman, Nicobars, Kashmir, Ladakh C & SW India (Source: Ali 1996, Grimmett and Inskipp 2007, http://www.bnhsenvis.nic.in/ ) Migration Routes of birds within India The flights of many migrating birds follow specific routes, sometimes quite welldefined, over long distances. Geographic factors, ecological conditions and meteorological conditions determine such routes. The majority of migrants travel along broad airways within these flyways with minor changing their flight direction in response to the direction and force of the wind. It has been estimated that birds generally fly at heights varying from 500 to 900 m, at speed ranging between 30 and 100km/h, and often fly continuously for 6 to 11 hours/day with an average of 240 to 970 km, before stopping to eat or rest (CSIR 1990). 112 113 Various migratory birds, having native places throughout the Europe, Asia, Africa, Arctic region etc., arrive through different migratory routes in India. Bitterns breeds in the temperate Palaearctic Region throughout Europe and Asia from Great Britain to Japan. These winter visitors are recorded from Rajasthan eastwards to Assam and Orissa and southwards to Karnataka (Table 2, Route 1; Fig 1). White stork is recorded as a winter visitor between September and October, and March-April from North India eastwards to West Bengal and southwards to Tamil Nadu. It breeds in Northern Europe, North Africa, and Western Asia (Table 2, Route 2; Fig 1). White fronted goose is sparse and rare winter visitor to NW India eastwards to Assam and Manipur (Table 2, Route 4; Fig 1). Barheaded goose breeds in Ladakh and is winter visitor in Assam and southwards to Karnataka between October–November and March (Table 2, Route 7; Fig 1). Accordingly, based on available literature (CSIR 1990, Ali 1979, ZSI 1991, Ripley 1982, Whistler and Kinnear 1949, Walters 1980, Grimmett and Inskipp, 2007, Hawkins 1986), the native places elsewhere of commonly visible avifauna and their migratory routes within India are documented in Table 2 and depicted in Fig. 1. In general, migration of birds into India is restricted to a main route. The Kutch, Banaskantha and Kathiawar Peninsula are on this main route through which hordes of migratory birds sweep into India from the North and NW in autumn and out in the reverse direction in spring. This region also forms the eastern fringe of many Asiatic passage migrants. 113 114 LEGEND Route no. (as per Table 2) 2* : also route 14 4* : also route 10 11* : also route 12 16* : also route 17 Fig.1: Migratory routes of birds within India 114 115 Table 2. Migratory routes of birds within India Route Native place No. Temperate palaearctic region throughout 1 Europe & Asia from Great Britain to Japan 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 Migratory routes within India Birds Rajasthan eastwards to Assam & Orissa and Bitterns southwards to Karnataka North India eastwards to Northern Europe, North west Bengal & southwards Africa & Western Asia to Tamil Nadu North India eastwards to Europe through Russia to Assam & southwards to North China Maharashtra Arctic coasts of Europe & North west India eastwards Asia to Assam & Manipur Kashmir eastwards to Siberia Assam & southwards to Maharashtra North India eastwards to Europe, Asia Minor & Assam & southwards to Central Asia Andhra Pradesh Assam & southwards to Ladakh Karnataka Western Europe, Central Kashmir eastwards to Asia, eastern Siberia, Assam & Manipur and Mongolia & Tibet southwards to Maharashtra Assam and southwards to Kashmir, Europe, Asia Maharashtra North West India Europe, Central and eastwards to Assam & Western Siberia Manipur and southwards to Karnataka Europe & Asia from North India (Punjab, Delhi) Scandinavia to Siberia & eastwards to Assam and South to Volga, southwards to Gujarat Turkestan & Amur Southern Europe & North & North West India Southern Russia and southwards to Gujarat North East India viz. Assam, Manipur & West Northern Siberia Bengal thinly diffuses westwards to Rajasthan 115 White stork Black stork White goose fronted Lesser white fronted goose Eastern goose grayleg Barheaded goose Common shelduck Mallard Common pochard Smew Imperial eagle Eastern plover golden 116 14 Northern & central Europe, Western Asia etc. 15 Eastern Europe & Russia 16 Central Eurasia 17 Southern Siberia 18 Afghanistan, North Iran, Turkestan & Transcaspia 19 Central Siberia 20 Transcaspia to the Gobi desert 21 West China & Tibet 22 Mongolia 23 Tibet & West China 24 Turkey, Lake Baikal, Manchuria & Kansu 25 26 and southwards to Kerala North India eastwards to West Bengal and southwards through Peninsula Western Himalayan foothills southwards to Karnataka MP eastwards to Nagaland & Manipur and southwards to Kanniyakumari MP eastwards to Assam and southwards to Kanniyakumari Delhi & Kolkata southwards to Kanniyakumari Foothills of the Himalayas southwards to Tamil Nadu and eastwards to West Bengal Northeastern India (Haryana) southeastern to Gujarat Lower Himalayas from Naini Tal eastwards through Sikkim & Arunachal Pradesh Gangetic plains of U.P & Bihar southwards to West Bengal Himalayan foothills from Himachal Pradesh eastwards to Assam, Meghalaya ,Nagaland & Arunachal Pradesh Plains of Northwestern India upto Gujrat and eastwards to U.P Black godwit tailed Western breasted flycatcher Blyth’s warbler red reed Siberian booted tree warbler Indian booted tree warbler Siberian lesser whitethroat Small whitethroat Hodgson’s redstart Hodgson’s chat bush Tibetan collared bush chat Isabelline chat Lake Baikal , Manchuria, Ladakh to Lahul Spiti Pleschanka’s chat Iran & the Black sea Himalayas, Nepal Himalayas (Kulu valley to Pied ground 116 117 27 Eastern Russia, Siberian Taiga & Yenisey 28 Siberia 29 Turkestan 30 Southern Siberia & Japan 31 Scandinavia Northwestern Siberia 32 Central palaearctic region from Volga to Baikalia and Ladakh 33 Russian Turkestan 34 North Eurasia, Central Russia etc. 35 South eastern Tibet & western Szechuan 36 Baltic sea to central Siberia Altic sea to central Siberia 37 Siberia & Arunachal Pradesh) Himalayas (Arunachal Pradesh, Nagaland, Manipur, Assam) southwards to M.P & Orissa Himalayas eastwards to Arunachal Pradesh ,Nagaland & Manipur Along the Himalayan foothills to Dehradun Along the Himalayan westwards to Shimla Along the Gangetic plains southwards in Kanniyakumari and eastwards in Assam and also Andaman & Nicobar Islands Gangetic plains southwards to Kerala and eastwards to Assam & also Nicobar Islands Himalayan foothills eastwards in U.P and southwards in Kerala Kashmir and eastwards to Mussoorie Eastern Himalayas through Sikkim to Arunachal Pradesh Indian Peninsula & the Western Himalayan foothills extending to Nepal Kashmir eastwards to Nepal thrush Black thrush throated Red thrush throated Turkestan black throated accentor Siberia tree pipit Grey headed yellow wagtail Blue headed yellow wagtail Turkestan black headed wagtail Brambling Tibetan siskin Common finch rose Pine bunting Conservation of birds There are reports that certain bird species in India have almost become extinct, and many more are becoming extremely rare and increasingly endangered. Anthropogenic activities have been primarily affecting the birds. The various 117 118 factors which are affecting the natural avian ecosystems are: human population explosion, growth and developmental activities, such as urbanization, buildings of roads, construction of dams, deforestation, hunting, trapping and exploitation. Environmental pollution is another cause endangering birds. Bio-accumulation of chemical fertilizers, pesticides, insecticides, herbicides etc., which are being increasingly and indiscriminately used, affects birds. Studies have shown that 65 percent of bird’s extinctions are due to destruction and alteration of habitats in which birds live. Hunting comes next, accounting for 25 percent of the extinction. The International Union for Conservation of Nature and natural Resources (IUCN) is a leading, International non–Govt. organization concerned with conservation. it co-ordinates selection and management of World Wide Fund conservation projects around the world, manages the UN Environment Programme (UNEP) and the secretariat of the convention on International trade in Endangered species of wild fauna and flora (CITES), and also performs the bureau duties under the conservation of wetlands of International importance, especially of waterfall habitat. World Wide Fund for Nature (WWF) International is the world’s largest voluntary organization raising funds for promoting conservation. Certain birds get protection in the form of religious beliefs, superstitions and popular sentiments. Pelicans are looked upon as sacred and in many parts of the country; people do not allow them to be killed by anyone. The peafowl or Indian peafowl is also considered as sacred and has found a place in mythology, literature and folklore. The White stork, Sarus crane and Siberian crane also enjoy varying degrees of protection by popular sentiment. Pigeons for certain other regions, get protection; mosques and some buildings have special steeples, ledges and windows to enable pigeons to roost and breed. The Indian Board for Wildlife is the main advisory body of the Govt. on the subject of Wildlife conservation and their important functions are: to devise ways and means for the conservation of wildlife through co-ordinated legislative and practical measures, to sponsor the setting up of National Parks, Wildlife Sanctuaries and Zoological Parks, to advice the Govt.on policy in respect of export of living animals, trophies, skins, furs, feathers and other wildlife products etc. The Indian Wildlife (Protection) Act, 1972 provides legal protection to endangered species of animals. Protection of wild animals, birds, and forests has also been included in the Indian Constitution. Since the right kind of habitat is critical for birds to survive and reproduce, it makes sense that habitat management is an important focus of bird conservation. The quality of resources and the protection they provide is important to understand when trying to discern birds' migration timetables and flight paths. 118 119 References Able, K. P., and Beltoff, J. R. (1998). Rapid ‘evo­lution’ of migratory behavior in the introduced House Finch of eastern North America. Proceedings of the Royal Society of London Series B 265: 2063–2071. Agarwal, M. (2011). Migratory birds in India: Migratory birds dwindling New Global Indian (http://newglobalindian.com/nature). Alerstam T., Hedenström, A. and Åkesson, S. (2003). Long-distance migration: evolution and determinants. Oikos 103: 247–260. Ali, S. (1996). The book of Indian birds, 11th Edn., Oxford University Press, New Delhi. Ali, S (1979). Bird study in India: Its history and its importance. Indian Council for Cultural Relations, New Delhi. Ali, Salim (1962). Migratory Wagtails in Kerala. Journal of the Bombay Natural History Society. 59(1): 294–296. Bayliss, P. (1989). Population dynamics of magpie geese in relation to rain fall and density – implications for harvest models in fluctuating environment. Journal of Applied Ecology 26, 913–924. Bopinwar,S. S., Meshram, D.B., Bharati, M.T., Paunikar W.N. and Ghosh, T.K. (2012). Diversity of Birds in Some Ecological Niches of Western Ghats in Maharashtra (India). Research and Reviews in Bioscience. Manuscript no. : Re750212943 (in press). Council of Scientific and Industrial Research (CSIR), (1990). Birds: Supplement to the Wealth of India, Raw Materials. Vol. 2B. CSIR, India. Donald (1952). referred in Animal resources of India: Protozoa to Mammalia; State of the Art. Zoological Survey of India (ZSI), Kolkata, 1991 119 120 Gauthreaux, S.A., Jr., and Belser, C.G., (2005). Radar ornithology and the conservation of migratory birds, in Ralph, C.J., and Rich, T.D., eds., Bird conservation implementation and integration in the Americas, Vol.1. Proceedings of the Third International Partners in Flight Conference, Asilomar, Calif., March 20-24, 2002: Albany, Calif., U.S. Department of Agriculture, Forest Service, Pacific Southwest Research Station, general technical report PSW-GTR-191, p. 871–875. George (1964). referred in Animal resources of India: Protozoa to Mammalia; State of the Art. Zoological Survey of India (ZSI), Kolkata, 1991. Grimmett, R. and Inskipp, T. (2007). Birds of Southern India. Om Books International, New Delhi, India. Hawkins, R.E. (1986). Encyclopedia of Indian Natural History, BNHS, Oxford University Press, Mumbai. Khacher (1978). referred in Animal resources of India: Protozoa to Mammalia; State of the Art. Zoological Survey of India (ZSI), Kolkata, 1991. Lack D. (1968). Bird migration and natural selection. Oikos 19: 1–9. Mathew (1971). referred in Animal resources of India: Protozoa to Mammalia; State of the Art. Zoological Survey of India (ZSI), Kolkata, 1991. Newton, I. (2008). Migration ecology of birds, Academic Press, London, UK. Ripley, S.D. (1982). A synopsis of the birds of India and Pakistan together with those of Nepal, Sikkim, Bhutan and Ceylon (2nd Edn) Bombay Natural History Society, Mumbai. Sillett, T. S. and Holmes, R. T. (2002). Variation in survivorship of a migratory songbird throughout its annual cycle. Journal of Animal Ecology 71: 296–308. Walters, M. (1980).The complete Birds of the World. David and Charles, London. Webster, M.S. and Marra, P.P. (2005). The importance of understanding migratory connectivity and cross-seasonal interactions. Birds of two worlds (ed. 120 121 R. Greenberg and P. Marra), PP. 199–209, Johns Hopkins University Press, Baltimore, Massachusetts, USA. Whistler, H. and Kinnear, N.B. (1949). Popular Handbook of Indian Birds. Oliver & Bovd, Edinburgh & London. Zoological Survey of India (1991). Animal resources of India: Protozoa to Mammalia; State of the Art. ZSI, Kolkata. 121 122 Journal of Today’s Biological Sciences: Research & Review (JTBSRR) ISSN 2320-1444 (Online) JTBSRR Vol.1, Issue 1, page 122-143, December 30, 2012 Available on: www.jtbsrr.in Flowering Manipulation In Mango: A Science Comes of Age J. Shankara Swamy Department of Horticulture, Junagadh Agricultural University Junagadh -362001, Gujarat E-mail: shankara.swamy@gmail.com Abstract The Mango (Mangifera indica L.), member of family Anacardiaceae, is amongst the most important tropical fruit of the world. Flowering is the first of several events that set the stage for mango (Mangifera indica L.) production each year. Given favorable growth conditions, the timing and intensity of flowering greatly determines when and how much fruit are produced during a given season. Insight into this phenomenon has been of prime interest to scientists and growers for over a century. As a consequence of efforts to elucidate the mechanisms in manipulation of flowering in mango becoming clearer at the molecular, biochemical, and physiological levels resulting in a better understanding of how to manipulate flowering in the field is critically reviewed here. Key words: Flowering manipulation, growth regulators, mango flowering Introduction The Mango (Mangifera indica L.), one of the 73 genera of the family Anacardiaceae in order Sapindales, is amongst the most important tropical fruits of the world. It is also called as king of the fruits (Purseglove, 1972). It is originated in the South East Asia or Indo-Burma Region having 41 recognized species of mango originating as forest trees with fibrous and resinous fruits ((Mukherjee, 1951, 1967).The mango (Mangifera indica L.) is an important fruit crop of India and other tropical and subtropical regions of the world. It is grown in more than 111 countries but no where it is as greatly valued as in India where 122 123 40 % of total fruits grown is only mango. In India, mango enjoys supreme place in fruit production has nearly 1000 varieties and grown in an area of 1.60 million hectare, which accounts for 58 % of total area under fruit crops (Anon., 2008). In the year 2006-07, India exported 79,060.88 MT of mangoes worth Rs.141.94 crores (APEDA, 2007). India is the largest producer of mango in the world with the production of approximately 14 million tones, contributing more than 57 % share of the world production (FAO, 2009). The profitability of growing mango is influenced by two key factors: • Productivity, which consists of yield and quality. • Supply and demand which rule market prices. A better understanding of the nature of flowering induction in mango is necessary not only for yield sustainability but also for yield increase. Flowering is the first of several events that set the stage for mango (Mangifera indica L.) production each year. Given favorable growth conditions, the timing and intensity of flowering greatly determines when and how much fruits are produced during a given season. Insight into this phenomenon has been of prime interest to scientists and growers for over a century. I, therefore have chosen to discuss advance flowering in mango crop. As one reflects over nearly a century of work in mango fruit crop production, it is apparent that the area early/regular flowering induction in mango was received less attention in the past. Although many significant mileposts have been reached in our understanding of mango flowering induction in the past 30 years. Flowering phenomena in mango Flower initiation is very important because it is the first step towards attaining fruit and it is very complex phenomena in mango. Flowering in mango trees make them especially challenging for physiologists, breeders, and growers; Mango is a terminal bearing species and the factors which determine switching from vegetative to reproductive mode are poorly understood. In general first, mango pass through a juvenile stage which lasts for several years following germination during which flowering does not occur; second, interactions between vegetative growth, flowers, and fruit of the previous year on floral initiation in the current year, affect growers through phenomena such as biennial bearing, and make interpretation of research data difficult for scientists. Once flowering capacity is attained, mango tree respond to environment cues such as light (especially relative lengths of light and dark periods), temperature and nutrition. In mango flowering has been found to be chemically controlled. Leaves are the sites of control substance synthesis; apices are receptor sites. It has 123 124 been suggested that this control may takes the form of: (a) a single flowering factor (florigen), (b) a group of flower promoting substances, (c) one or more flower inhibiting substances, or (d) interaction between flowering promoters and inhibitors and vegetative growth cycle. These aspects are reviewed as follows. 1. Growth pattern and flushing episodes in relation to mango flowering Induction of generative (floral), vegetative or mixed shoots from axillary or apical buds of mature flushes appears to be governed by several factors reviewed in details as follows. Growth of mango is not continuous but it occurs as intermittent, short lasting flushes of shoots from apical or lateral buds. The flushing refers to the emergence of new shoots on the terminals of old shoots. Generally a healthy mango shoot completes four to five flushing episodes per year depending upon cultivars and growing condition (Davenport and Nunez-Elisea, 1997), while blooming occurs on a few of them during the following year (Issarakraisila et al., 1991). Terminal inflorescences or panicles are initiated in dormant apical buds on stems that developed vegetative from lateral buds following the previous flowering seasons (Litz, 1997). So studying the different vegetative growth cycles may help the mango growers to know the most important vegetative growth cycle for regulation of vegetative growth, bearing flowers, fruits subsequently to increase yield. In this case the growers can use all methods for inducing trees to produce their vegetative growth cycles in the time which help to maximize income. According to the Davenport and Nunez-Elisea (1997) Conceptual flowering model of mango, individual stems borne on branches of mango trees are in rest or a quiescent mode most of the time. Stems are resting, vegetative structures composed of the terminal intercalary unit resulting from the previous flush of vegetative growth. Stems are different from shoots, which are growing structures that evoke from buds of stems. Vegetative shoots bear only leaves, whereas generative shoots produce inflorescences and mixed shoots produce both leaves and inflorescences within the same nodes. Initiation of shoot growth in buds of resting stems is the first event that must occur in order to produce flowering (Davenport and NunezElisea, 1997; Davenport, 2000, 2008). Reece et al. (1946, 1949) recognized that the fate of mango buds is not determined until their growth is initiated. The vegetative or reproductive fate of resting apical or lateral mango buds is not predetermined at the time of shoot initiation (Mustard and Lynch, 1946; NunezElisea and Davenport, 1992). 124 125 New shoots arise mostly as laterals from axillary buds around the stump of the twigs fruited previous year. Such growth either remains unextended or makes further extension growth in subsequent months, largely depending on the variety. Terminal growth is always in the form of an extension of shoots already produced. Growth occurs in different flushes which vary from variety to variety and under different environmental conditions. Under north Indian conditions, March-April and May-June are the most important periods for the emergence of new shoots. However, stray shoots and sporadic extension growth may emerge any time between July and October (Singh, 1958}. Under south Indian conditions, two active flushes occurring from February to June and October to November were reported. Three main growth flushes in February to March, March to April and October to November were reported in western India. Only one or rarely two periods of active growth in the dry zone of Ceylon were reported by Buell (1954). However, he reported two to six growth flushes in the wet zone which was attributed to the irregular fruiting found in that zone. Nakasone et al (1955) reported that under Hawaiian conditions, the vegetative flushes in Pairie mango are scattered throughout the year. An average of 18 months was considered necessary by them between vegetative flush and subsequent flowering. Based on earlier works, it was proposed that early initiation and cessation of growth, followed by a definite dormant period, will help the shoots to attain proper physiological maturity essential for fruit bud Initiation that means floral behaviour of a shoot influences by its physiological position within the canopy. However, now it is more or less established that growth of shoots in mango is a varietal characteristic and their fruit bud differentiation in regular bearing cultivars is an annual feature. In biennial bearing varieties, ‘on’ and ‘off’ year phases, rather than age and cessation of growth of shoots govern the flower bud differentiation in the trees. The shoot, depending upon the cultivar may stop putting forth extension growth after May or continue until September or later and the potential of this shoot to form flower buds will depend on the floriferous condition of the tree, which in turn will be determined by the amount of fruit load carried by the tree in the previous year (Singh, 1971). 2. Flowering manipulation by interrupting vegetative growth cycle Mangoes are considered alternate bearers, although they are less severely alternate than avocadoes. There is some lack of clarity about their cropping habits and often alternation is used as synonyms for poor yield. One of the most important factors responsible for low yield and inferior orchard efficiency is biennial bearing, which means that the tree carries optimum load of crop in one year, but in the following year it fails to flower or/ and produce unsatisfactory crop. Biennial bearing, alternate bearing or cropping periodicity in mango 125 126 cropping is synonyms, which are different from unfruitfulness and shy cropping. The most important thing in case of flowering in mango is to produce new vegetative growth in the ‘on’ year which should also be mature to be ready to enter into reproduction phase and give out flower in following season. Flushes of one month may re-flush during the subsequent months. Similarly April flushes, which are considered to be the more productive may re-grow several times during the following months or may cease to grow anymore to attain blooming maturity and thus this becomes essential to determine pattern of growth of this flush. Most of the vegetative growth produced is from non-flowering shoots and the shoots, which carried mature fruits, have been reported to have markedly lower probability of vegetative growth (Issarakraisila & Considine, 1991). Moreover, induction of early flowering results in early maturity of the mango fruits which fetch the higher price in the market as compared to late maturing mango fruits. This can be achieved by various ways reviewed as follows. 2.1 By application of Triazoles group (paclobutrazol (PBZ)) growth inhibitor compounds The first report in the use P333 (paclobutrazol) @ 1.25 to 10 g.a.i/tree One of commercialized method to manipulate flowering by post- harvest application to the soil significantly promotes flowering and fruiting in the following year in Dashehari and Banganapalli came from India (Kulkarni, 1988). Davis et al (1986) Reported that paclobutrazol is substituted triazole, checking vegetative growth by inhibiting the biosynthesis of gibberellins in plants by blocking the conversion of kaurene and kaurenoic acid. Burondkar and Gunjate (1993) studied the effect of Paclobutrazol on Alphonso mango at regional fruit research station, vengurla and revealed that Paclobutrazol significantly suppressed the emergence of September-October vegetative flush and length of vegetative shoot in 2 successive cropping years. Tandel, Y. N. and Patel (2011) reported the beneficial effect of paclobutrazol, irrespective of time of application, reduced the vegetative growth during October-November under Gujarat condition in India. Paclobutrazol applied in mid of July, significantly reduced the number of shoots per terminal in Alphonso, Kesar and Rajapuri. It also checked the growth of new shoots in Alphonso, Kesar and Rajapuri. An application of paclobutrazol (cultar) had effectively controlled the emergence of this vegetative flush of OctoberNovember by interrupting the biosynthesis of gibberellins. Because paclobutrazol is a gibberellins bio-synthesis inhibitor. Application of paclobutrazol (cultar) in mid of July, August and September under Gujarat condition in India suppressed the vegetative growth and induced early and profuse flowering during their investigation as compared to control. The considerable reduction in vegetative growth in the trees treated with paclobutrazol had been reported by Hoda et al.(2001); Shinde et al. (2000). In other words, the flower inductive cycle which is a part of phonological and 126 127 physiological cycle of mango tree may commence earlier in the season, but flowering is prevented by the inhibitor until the build-up of sufficient promoter to counteract the inhibitor. Paclobutrazol thus, appears to help in achieving this stage much earlier because of its inhibitory activity. This hypothesis looks particularly attractive while considering the flower-inhibitory role of gibberellins in trees together with the anti-gibberellins activity of paclobutrazol (Kulkarni, 1991). 2.1.1 Disadvantages of paclobutrazol Although the direct effects of paclobutrazol(PBZ) on early induction of flowering of mango have been well documented, However, it seemed have average weight of a fruit reduced without affecting the fruit yield and continuous application of PBZ may cause soil pollution and its residual effect may increase in fruit. Residual limit of PBZ accepted by the FAO in stone fruit is 0.05 mg/kg (Singh and Ram, 2000). According to the Davenport (1993) there are problems with use of paclobutrazol. Because it inhibits the gibberellin syntheses pathway, levels of the gibberellin which is responsible for internode elongation, possibly GA1 are reduced. Although fruit set and yield may be increased, the product produces a compressed panicle which does not dry out very well and can develop powdery mildew or anthracnose even after light dew. Another problem is that when paclobutrazol is applied to soil in excess, under certain conditions, subsequent growth and normal development can be severely disrupted. There is a growing amount of literature on the use of paclobutrazol to get early and more uniform flowering in mangoes. No response was observed in seven or eight months after applying paclobutrazol to trees in Homestead. The trees then went through a freeze, their irrigation system failed, and major scaffolding branches were killed. The trees were severely pruned to remove dead wood. The ensuing growth lacked normal node elongation. Trees having only 1 gram of active ingredient applied are still severely stunted after over six years. They investigated the possibility that pruning of the major branches following application was the cause of the undesirable stunting of growth. We applied paclobutrazol, in the same concentration, to trees and waited three years before severely pruning. There was no response to the product until after the trees were pruned. The resulting growth was as severely stunted as before. We believe that this material is chromatographing itself up through the xylem of the tree. It is apparently concentrating itself in main trunks and slowly metering itself out to the branches. When main branches are cut, forcing buds to grow in the area of high paclobutrazol concentration, then you see this strong effect. As long as you do not prune the tree, there appears to be no problem and a many-times limited effect. Recommendations used in Thailand of 1.5 to 2 g/tree/yr to stimulate 127 128 more uniform flowering may eventually result in this kind of damage if and when they prune those trees for some reason. Paclobutrazol is persistent in the soil. If a new tree is planted, it will show the same symptoms. Therefore, we have to be careful when recommending use of such a compound. Experiments are being conducted in Central America on 'Tommy Atkins'. They involve applying paclobutrazol sprays at 30 ppm, which is its solubility in water, to get it to the buds at the proper time to facilitate a flowering response. 3. Environmental cues in relation to the flowering In the tropical evergreen tree mango, Mangifera indica L., cool temperature is the only factor known to induce flowering, but does not ensure floral initiation will occur because there are important interactions with vegetative growth. Vegetative activity and the relationship between vegetative and floral growth is variable, both from tree to tree and between years (Scholefield et al., 1986; Cull, 1987). Environmental induction through low temperature (around 15oC) is considered as the most important flower trigging element in mango still biennially bearing mango cultivars usually do not flower during off year even under low temperature conditions. Mango is a terminal bearing species and the factors which determine switching from vegetative to reproductive mode are poorly understood, although a period of low temperature (<18 ºC) during the pre-flowering period is thought to be involved (Davenport and Nunez-Elisea, 1997). It is commonly accepted that opportunities for flowering are maximized as the terminals become more mature (Scholefield et al., 1986), possibly due to the presence of floral inhibitors in young leaves (Kulkarni, 1991). Sen and Mallik (1941) working under Sabour conditions of Bihar reported that there was a sharp change in climatic conditions at the end of September especially with the advent of cold and dry weather appeared to influence fruit bud differentiation. Singh (1960) reported that neither the high humidity and rain at the time of bloom nor the late rains appeared to influence fruit-bud differentiation. However according to Chacko and Randhawa (1971) heavy rains during the critical time of flower-bud-intiation stimulated vegetative growth at the expense of flowering. In places like Kerala, where rainfall is heavy, mango flowered sparsely and erratically. Singh (1961) also observed that the mango trees in extreme humid place and under mild climatic conditions remained unfruitful owing to their increased tendency towards vegetative growth. A low temperature resulting in frost was reported to have effected the fruit-bud formation indirectly in the cultivars ‘Singharha’ and ‘Vijai Rao Garh’. He further observed that the regular bearing cultivars remained unaffected and no definite relation between the temperature and the extent of ‘bud break’. Chacko and Randhawa (1971) found that unlike many other tropical species, vegetative 128 129 growth in mango was never continuous but exhibited periodical quiescence. The number of flushes varied greatly depending upon the variety, age of the tree, climatic conditions and the amount of crop borne in the previous season. They also reported that although flowering in mango trees generally took place during short days in the areas fall nearer to the equator, the very fact that off-season cropping was possible at Kanyakumari in South India suggested that flowering in mango is certainly under the environmental control, most probably photoperiod. They also reported that mango trees responded to temperature variations more critically than to photoperiods as evidenced by the different times of flowering at different places in India. The flowering is known to be earlier in areas nearer to the equator and late in North India, where extreme low temperature prevails during the winter months. In tropical conditions, preflowering rest period is usually achieved by drought at temperature above 15 degree Celsius (Whiley et al., 1989). Nunez-Elisea and Davenport (1992) reported that production of reproductive shoots requires initiation of growth during exposure to cool, inductive condition. The resting buds of plants, which had been exposed to cool temperatures (18 degree Celsius day/10 degree Celsius night) for more than three weeks and then transferred to a warm temperature regime (30 degree Celsius day/25 degree Celsius night) before initiation occurred, typically produce vegetative growth. The primary impact of water stress on mango is to prevent vegetative flushing during stress period. The accumulating age of stems is greater in water stressed trees than the trees maintained under well watered condition. (Schaffer et al., 1994). Flowering occurs in the subtropics when resting buds initiate growth during cool, inductive temperatures (Battern and Mcconchi 1995). Yeshtela et al., (2004) found out that mango cultivar 'Keitt' was more sensitive towards low temperature floral induction than 'Tommy Atkins’. In the tropical highlands and sub-tropics, where most of the commercial orchards are situated, the low temperature during the winter months induced a severe growth check resulting in profuse flowering (Beal and Newman 1986). Rao (1998) reported that the minimum temperature of 13ºC for seven days favored FBD in mango cultivars ‘Neelum’ and ‘Totapuri’ under Dharwad conditions. Chen et al., (1999) reported that the temperature is considered to be key environmental factor, with low temperatures (19 ºC in day and 13 ºC in night) favorable for fruit-bud-differentiation. Li et al., (2010) recently reported that flower bud differentiation was delayed by high temperature and superabundant rainfall in subtropical monsoon climate zone and more easily affected by the overlap of current shoot growth. 3.1 An alternative flowering manipulation to dependence on Environmental signals Biennially bearing mango cultivars usually do not flower during off year even under low temperature conditions. In such circumstances. An alternative to 129 130 dependence upon environmental signals for flower initiation is the development of management strategies that can substitute for these signals among them few methods for manipulating of mango flowering alternative to environmental cues are reviewed here. 3.1.1 Application of growth inhibitors In above circumstances, growth retarding chemicals, e.g. triazoles group (paclobutrazol, PBZ), that can stimulate or mimic the effects of the environmental factors in checking vegetative growth are some times used to correct such a situation (Nartvaranant et al., 2000) as reviewed above. 3.1.2 Smudging Smudging is making the Smokey fire below the tree canopy and allows smoke to pass through the foliage for several days. To produce heavy smoke, place green grasses on top of combustible materials such as dry leaves and coconut husks. Smudging is an early commercial method of inducing mango to flower (Wester, 1920). Gonzales(1923) and Borja and Bautista (1932) considered only mature shoots of 1 year or older with very brittle, dull grayish green to copper coloured leaves and plump terminal buds are suitable for smudging. Smudging of the mango is practiced in certain parts of the Philippines to obtain earlier and increased flowering of 'Carabao' and 'Pico' mango (Dutcher 1972; Gonzales 1923; Madamba 1978). Ethylene has been identified as the active agent responsible for flowering during smudging (Dutcher 1972). Smudging is done continuously for several days and is stopped if flower buds do not appear within two weeks. The process may be repeated 1-2 months later, but results are uncertain. It is not, however, known to be practised in India or in any other mango tract, or even much widely in the Philippines. According to Sen and Mallik (1947) Experiments were conducted at the Fruit Research Station, Bihar, and Sabour India with the Langra Mango in order to study the effect of smudging treatment on the plant under the local conditions. Instead of flowering smudging has stimulated vegetative growth. In addition to normal shoots arising from terminals large number of axillary buds appeared in clusters to form malformed bunchy growths. It is apparent that smudging has a stimulating effect on growth, but the nature of growth, reproductive or vegetative, depends on other factors. One of the previous workers also concludes that smudging can induce flowering only if the shoot is in condition to flower. But none of them mention any effect of stimulating excessive vegetative growth as shown in these experiments. Opinion differs as to whether the smudging is due to heat of the smudge or due to smoke. It is not considered to be due to the 130 131 heat as the average difference of temperature between the treatment and the control was only 2°C. According to them Ethylene gas which is one of the chief constituents of the smudge smoke, produced by burning vegetative matter, are known to have given similar effect on pineapple. It is, therefore, thought that stimulating effect of smudging is due to the smoke. So they declared that it is intended to continue the study in connection with researches on the physiology of the mango. 3.1.3 Potassium nitrate spray KNO3 can enhance flowering especially in tropical regions where cold temperature for floral induction may not be sufficient. That is due to its reported effect in supplementing nitrogen. It is also suggested that induction by potassium nitrate spray occur as a result of ethylene synthesis. The overall effect of potassium nitrate when sprayed at different periods of phonological phases, concentration and locations as well as the mechanism for its effect is reviewed here. Potassium nitrate (KNO3) came into general use in the Philippines in the 1970s. It too was speculated to stimulate flowering through a wound-ethylene response. It now is widely used in Mexico as well. Although responses may occur at concentrations ranging from 1 to 8 percent, Mexican growers generally use 4 percent KNO3 or 2 percent ammonium nitrate. Leaf tip burn also occurs in dry areas at these concentrations. One must be careful in interpreting such information. Many have found that if KNO3 is applied too early in the season, they obtain a vegetative instead of a flowering growth response. The same is true for spring or summer applications. It is likely that KNO3 is not inducing flowering directly, but is stimulating initiation of growth. If conditions are present to induce flowering, then growth will be reproductive. If, on the other hand, conditions are more favorable for vegetative growth then, that will be the response. This point is further discussed below. Subsequent discovery and use of ethephon to replace smudging and stimulate flowering of mango the first studies to demonstrate that potassium nitrate could induce flowering of mango trees were from the Philippines (Barba 1974, Bondad and Linsangan 1979; Bueno and Valmayor 1974). Flowering was evident within seven days after treatment and was effective on shoots that were between 4.5 and 8.5 months old when treated. Bondad and Linsangan (1979) reported that concentrations of potassium nitrate between 1 and 8 percent stimulated flowering of seedling 'Carabao' and 'Pahutan' trees and 'Pico' trees within one week after sprays were applied. The treatment was effective for stimulating flowering of trees that had remained 131 132 vegetative well beyond normal bearing ages, for advancing the flowering and fruiting periods, and for breaking the biennial bearing habits of trees. Potassium nitrate is currently recommended in the Philippines for inducing uniform flowering and for the production of off-season fruits in the 'Pico' and 'Carabao' cultivars (Madamba 1978). In India, workers have reported variable results with potassium nitrate (Pal et. al. 1979). Areas that have reported success with potassium nitrate include Trinidad with 'Tommy Atkins' (James et al. 1992), the Ivory Coast with 'Kent' and 'Zill' (Goguey 1992) and Mexico with 'Manila' and 'Haden' (Nunez-Elisea 1985; 1986). Work in Mexico showed that mango flowering could also be stimulated with ammonium nitrate sprays (Macias-Gonzales et al. 1992; Nunez-Elisea 1988, Nunez-Elisea and Caldeira 1992). Concentrations of 2 percent ammonium nitrate were sufficient to promote early flowering in 'Haden', 'Tommy Atkins', 'Kent', 'Diplomatico' and 'Manila'. The similar results between ammonium and potassium nitrate indicate that the nitrate ion is the active portion of the molecule. Experiments in Hawaii by Mike and Melvin(1990) showed that 2 and 4 percent potassium nitrate sprays applied to mature seedling trees early in the flowering season (February, 1986) stimulated flowering. A single application stimulated flowering within three weeks after treatment, and maximum response was observed at about four weeks. Off-season flowering was also stimulated when application was made to seedling trees in May after the flowering season was completed. Nearly 16 percent of the terminals treated with 4 percent potassium nitrate flowered by six weeks after treatment. Their results also showed that terminals that flowered were associated with specific trees; some trees in the test exhibited no response, while others produced vegetative terminals after treatment. These results suggest that potassium nitrate did not induce flowering, but probably stimulated growth of terminal buds. Flowering was determined by the condition of the terminal bud or the environmental conditions at the time potassium nitrate application was made. Their results with seedling trees also showed that genotypic differences among trees exist with regard to flowering responses to potassium nitrate. Some trees were highly responsive to the treatment and flowered, while others produced vegetative shoots instead of panicles. In Mexico, studies by Nunez-Elisea (1986) have shown that 'Haden' shoots should be six months of age or older. In the case of 'Manila', shoots could be as young as 3-4 months of age and be responsive. Leaves should be dark green with a mature, "woody" texture and well developed terminal buds. Upon treatment with a 4 percent potassium nitrate solution, slight leaf wilting can be observed within two days, and at 10 days buds begin to swell. A second application is 132 133 made at 15-20 days after the first application if the response is poor. Application should be made prior to emergence of the flowers, because flowers are usually damaged by the potassium nitrate sprays. Harvesting occurs at about five months after treatment. Advancing the flowering season in Mexico has enabled growers to get fruits into the market at an earlier date, extend the harvest season, and harvest crops during the drier periods. Davenport (2003) reported that bud break was initiated three months later by a foliar application of KNO3 in weakly inductive condition (during warm temperature condition). In Veracruz, Mexico, PBZ was applied in July at 1g. a.i. per meter of canopy diameter combined with two foliar sprayings of KNO3 at 2% in October, and the flowering of mango ‘Manila’ took place 80 days ahead from the regular natural flowering; resulting in a selling price 15 times higher, as compared to the regular crop value for the season. Mosqueda (1989) reported that KNO3 was effective in stimulating the emergence of mango inflorescences more than 30 days in advance in Manila mango. Foliar application of KNO3 stimulated flowering of mango (Yeshitela et al., 2004). It is possible that KNO3 increased cell division and enlargement in the meristematic zone (Protacio, 2000). 3.1.4 Hormonal concept of flowering in mango Floral evocation and morphogenesis can achieve by the application of plant growth regulators or phytohormones and plant growth regulators (PGR) antagonists. PGRs are generally present in most plants, some of these compounds may be present or absent in sub or supra-optimal levels. Hence each factor will not necessarily act in the same direction in all plants. Work with exogenous application of PGRs for mango flowering and floral manipulation with their application comprehended here. 3.1.4.1 Hormonal concept Sen (1943) suggested that there might be a special hormone and that a heteroauxin might be discovered for practical use to induce flowering in mango. The terminal bud in mango was considered to inhibit the formation of axillary flower bud since the removal of terminal buds helped in producing inflorescence from axillary buds in the ‘Haden’ mango (Reece et al., 1946). Further, it was also shown that floral primordial in the axillary buds were promoted by the presence of leaves and inhibited by the decapitated and ringed shoots could induce axillary flower buds but when the shoots were defoliated immediately or within 133 134 twenty-four hours after decapitation, only vegetative shoots were produced by the axillary buds (Reece et al., 1949). On the basis of these observations, Chandler (1950) proposed a hypothesis that flower induction in mango could occur only when the cell division had started and that a flower inducing hormone played no part in the initiation of growth; but when present in sufficient amount at the beginning of growth, it determined the course of differentiation of tissue in the axillary buds. He also proposed that if a hormone induced flowering in plants and the source of hormone was the leaf or some precursor formed in the leaf, then the leaf surface rather than the accumulation of carbohydrates might have the dominant influence on flowering. Sen (1951) opined that the problem of floral initiation in plants is not as simple as the one being controlled by the synthesis and accumulation of a substance up to a certain concentration but is a complex one involving a photo-mechanism controlling various growth and developmental processes. Singh (1961) showed that the newly merged leaves in the shoots of regular bearing cultivars such as ‘Neelum’ was capable of synthesizing flower inducing hormone. Chacko and Randhawa (1971) noticed a situation wherein three-month-old seedlings of ‘Bangalora’ raised by stone grafting initiated flower buds, while in similar grafts of ‘Langra’ and ‘Alphonso’, the biennial bearing cultivars, only vegetative growth was produced. after two months, during December first week, flower bud emerged in case of ‘Bangalora’ grafts, whereas a second vegetative growth flush was observed in ‘Bangalora’ and ‘Alphonso’ grafts, demonstrating the inability of young leaves in biennial bearing cultivars to synthesize the flower inducing hormone. In the light of the above observation, it was proponed that the ‘on’ and ‘off’ year conditions in biennial bearing cultivars are governed by the synthesis (or non-synthesis) of a flower inducing stimulus which in turn depends upon the age and maturity conditions of the shoots. In regular bearing cultivars ‘on’ and ‘off’ year conditions do not exist possibly because of the production of the flower inducing hormone even in young leaves. Singh (1959) demonstrated that the flower inducing stimulus could be transmitted from a mature tree of juvenile mango seedlings through grafting resulting the flowering of young stock, however, he found that the donating action shoots failed to induce flower in the nondefoliated seedling stock. He proposed that the high level of auxins produced in the leaves of the acceptor seedling counteracted the action of the flowering hormone donated by the action, resulting in lack of flowering. The response flowering in the receptor seedling was the same irrespective of cultivar involved, indicating that the nature and action of flower inducing hormone was the same in both regular and biennial cultivars. Found that the donating action shoots failed to induce flower in the non-defoliated seedling stock. He proposed that the high level of auxins produced in the leaves of the acceptor seedling counteracted the action of the flowering hormone donated by the action, resulting in lack of flowering. The response flowering in the receptor seedling was the same 134 135 irrespective of cultivar involved, indicating that the nature and action of flower inducing hormone was the same in both regular and biennial cultivars. 3.1.4.1.1 Auxins Chacko (1968) found a high level of auxin-like substance in the shoots of ‘Dashehari’, which were expected to flower. The work of the same person on the naturally occurring growth substance in the shoots of ‘Dashehari’ and ‘Totapuri Red Small’ indicated the presence of a zone on paper chromatograms containing growth promoting substances, which exhibited biological properties similar to auxins. The shoots from ‘Dashehari’ ‘on’ year and ‘Totapuri Red Small’ trees, which initiated flower buds during the experimental period had a higher level of growth promoting substances during the period of flower-bud initiation than the shoots of ‘Dashehari’ ‘off’ trees which remained vegetative. Daschowdhary (1969) observed that in the neutral fraction of ‘Langra’ shoot extract, a growth promoting substance occurred at Rf 0.7 to 0.8 on paper chromatogram developed in isopropanol : ammonia : water. It was found that the highest concentration of the promoter coincided with the ripeness to flower stage. 3.1.4.1.2 Gibberellin-like substance In many of the cold-requiring biennials and long-day annual plants, Gibberellins are known to be involved in the production of floral stimulus. A study of Chacko (1968) showed that the amount of gibberellin-like substance was higher in the shoot extracts of ‘Dashehari’ ‘off’ season trees as compared with those of ‘on’ trees, which were differentiating fruit of grafted seedling as reported by Singh (1959) was interpreted by Singh (1971) as owing to its high content of endogenous gibberellins. 3.1.4.1.3 Cytokinin-like substances Relationships between mango flowering and the endogenous level of cutokinins studies were conducted on the endogenous cytokinins in the shoot tips of Dashehari mango between September and February in 'on' and 'off years (Agarwal et al, 1980). Eleven cytokinin-like substances were isolated in the 'on' year, including zeatm riboside and zeatin. Cytokinin levels at the time of flower bud differentiation (December to February) were higher in the 'on' year than in the ‘off’ year. These results suggested that flowering in mango shoot tips is associated with high levels of endogenous cytokinins. Chen (1981, 1983) isolated zeatin, zeatin riboside and other cytokinin-Iike substances from immature mango seeds. Cytokinin concentration in panicle and pulp of mango was highest 5 to 10 days after full bloom and decreased rapidly thereafter. Highest total cytokinin- 135 136 Iike activity was observed in the xylem sap also at the time of full bloom (Chen, 1987). 3.1.4.1.4 Ethylene Ethylene is unique in that it is the only gaseous phytohormone. It is usually present in a minute quantity of about 0.1 ppm and causes marked physiological effects in the plants. Some of the flower promoting effects in mango reviewed. 3.1.5 Floral manipulation in mango by application of exogenous plant hormones 3.1.5.1 Ethylene spray The ethylene-generating agent, ethephon, applied at 125-200 ppm, induced flowering of 'Carabao' mango in the Philippines within six weeks after treatment (Dutcher, 1972). Flower induction also occurred at concentrations between 500 and 1,000 ppm; however, defoliation was also experienced at the higher concentrations (Bondad, 1976). Ethephon has also been successful in India for increasing flowering of 'Langra and 'Deshehari' during "off' years (Chacko et al. 1972, 1974; Chadha and Pal, 1986) and for inducing earlier production in juvenile plants (Chacko et al. 1974). In 10-year-old 'Haden', 500-1,000 ppm applied one month before the normal flowering date increased flowering by 40-55 percent (Nunez-Elisea et al. 1980). These results are contrary to those obtained by Pal et al. (1979), who found ethephon ineffective after five consecutive years of treatment, and by Sen et al. (1978) who reported an increase in flowering during "on" years but failed to stimulate flowering during "off years. 3.1.5.2 Cutokinins spray Exogenous cytokinins cause promotion and inhibition of flower initiation in a variety of species, although promotive effects are much more frequent than inhibitory ones (Bernier et al., 1981). Elevated cytokinin levels have been implicated in breaking dormancy in adventitious and axillary buds (Stafstrom, 1995). Chen (1983) First time extensive study was carried out to clear that cytokinins are important factors in the regulation of flower bud initiation and development in mango trees. 3.1.5.3 6-Benzyl amino purine (6-BA) Chen (1987) described precocious bud break and flowering of mango shoots in response to an early October application of 100 ppm 6-Benzyl amino purine (6136 137 BA). Full flowering was observed one month following application compared with three months later on non treated trees. And made conclusion that the elevated cytokinin level found to prior to and during flowering and the flowering response to applied BA led to conclusion that cytokinins are involved in stimulation of bud break. Conclusion So far, the literature on floral manipulation in mango plants has been reviewed, it is apparent that floral initiation in trees is controlled by a range of factors which may include environmental stimuli, developmental cues, and other interactions with vegetative growth and PGRs. It is also apparent that rarely can one factor be considered in isolation. Research in trees is expensive, slow, and has often been focused on limits to production in perennial trees like mango. So application/ use of particular practice can be recommended strongly after through assessment of different methods /practices can be recommended and continuous Research efforts should be strengthened on flowering physiology especially in genetic control of flowering in mango. References Anonymous, 2011. Indian horticulture database: state wise area, production and yield of important horticulture crops in India for the year 2007-08 publication by national horticulture board, Gurgaon. pp: 106-115. APEDA (2007). Export statement of ten year data. Apeda scheduled products. Astudillo E.O and Bondad, N.D .(1978) Potassium Nitrate Induced Flowering of Carabao Mango Shoots at Different Stages of Maturity. Philippine Journal of Crop Science 3, 147-52. Battern, D. J. and Mcconchi, C. A. 1995. Floral induction in growing buds of lychee (Litchi chinensis) and mango (Mangifera indica). Australian J. Plant Physiol. 22:783-91. Bondad, N.D. 1976. Response of some tropical and subtropical fruits to pre- and post-harvest applications of ethephon. Economic Botany 30:67-80. Bernier, G., Kinet, J.M and Sachs, R.M. 1981.The physiology of flowering, Vol.I, Boca Raton, CRC Press. 137 138 Bondad, N.D., and E. Linsangan. 1979. Flowering in mango induced with potassium nitrate. Hort. Science 14:527-528. Bueno, P.B., and R.V. Valmayor. 1974. Potassium nitrate: Key to mango flowering. Agric. Los Banos 13:4. Borja, V. and Bautista.1932. Mango investigations in muntinlpa, Rizal. Philipp. J.Agric.3:111-143. Beal, P. R. and Newman, G. A. 1986. Climatic influence on mango Production in the Bowen district. Queensland J. Agric. Animal Sci. 43: 83-89. Buell, E P., 1954. Flowering and fruiting habits of the mango in the wet zone. Trop. Agric., 110: 280-284. Chacko, E. K. 1968. Studies on the physiology of flowering and fruit growth in mango (Mangifera indica L.). Ph.D. thesis submitted to P. G. School of IARI. Chacko, E.K, R.R. Kohli, and G.S. Randhawa. 1974. Investigations on the use of 2chloroethylphosphonic acid (Ethephon CEPA) for the control of bienniel bearing in mango. Scientia Horticulturae 2:389-398. Chacko, K. K. and Randhawa, G. S .1971.Towards an understanding of the factors affecting flowering in mango (Mangifera indica L.) Andhra Agric. J. 18: 226-36. Chadha, K.L. and R.N. Pal, 1986. Mangifera indica. In: Halevy, A.C. (ed.) CRC Handbook of Flowering, Vol. 5: 211–30. CRC Press, Boca Raton, Florida. Chandler, W. H. 1950. Evergreen Orchards. Lea and Febiger, Philadelphia, USA. Chen, W.S. 1981. Physiological studies of fruiting in mango trees. II. Effect of endogenous growth substance on fruiting. Proc Natl Sci Counc Repub China 5: 49-55. Chen, W.S. 1983. Cytokinins of the developing mango fruit: Isolation, identification, and changes in levels during maturation. Plant Physiol. 71:356-361. Chen, W.S. 1987. Endogenous growth substances in relation to shoot growth and flower bud development of mango. J. Amer. Soc. Hort. Sci.112:360-363. Chen, J.Z., Zhao, H., Chen, J. L. and Zhao, H.Y.1999. Advances in research on flower-bud-differentiation in mango. South China Fruits 28(2): 34-35. 138 139 Cull, B.W., 1987. A whole plant approach to productivity research for mango. In: Prinsley, R.T., Tucker G. (Eds.), Mangoes—A Review. The Commonwealth Secretariat, London, pp. 19–28. Daschowdhury, T. K. 1969. Physiological studies on factors governing Fruit-bud differentiation in mango (Mangifera indica L.). D. Phil. Agri.) thesis, Univ. of Calcutta. Davenport, T. L. 1992. Beneficial effects of water stress. In: Davenport, T. L. and Harrington, H.M. (eds.) Proceedings of the Plant Stress In the Tropical Environment, VSDA/CSRS/CBAG, Gaomesville, Florida, pp. 16-20. Davenport, T.L. 1993. Floral manipulation in mangos. In: Chia LE, Evans DO (eds), Proceedings of the Conference on Mango in Hawaii. Cooperative Extension Service, University of Hawaii. Honolulu, Hawaii, pp.54-60. Davenport, T.L. 2003. Management of flowering in three tropical and subtropical fruit tree species. Hort.Science 38:1331-1335. Davenport, T.L. 2008. Reproductive physiology. In: Litz RE (ed), The Mango, Botany, Production and Uses. 2nd Edition. CAB International, Wallingford Oxon. In press. Davenport TL, Nunez-Elisea R (1997) Reproductive physiology. In: Litz RE (ed), The Mango, Botany, Production and Uses, pp.69-146. CAB International, Wallingford Oxon. Davenport, T.L., Nunez-Elisea, R., 1997. Reproductive physiology. In: Litz, R.E. (Ed.), the Mango: Botany, Production and Uses. CAB International, Oxon, pp. 69– 146. Davis, T.D., Sankhla, N. and Upadhyaya, S.K. and Srivastava, V.S., 1986. Effect of growth substances on fruit retention in mango (Mangifera indica L.) variety Langra and Dashehari. Proceedings of International Symposium Tropical and Sub tropical Horticulture, New Delhi, Dec. 1967, pp. 225-229. Dutcher, R.D. 1972. Induction of early flowering in 'Carabao' mango in the Philippines by smudging and ethephon application. Hort.Science 7:343. Dutcher, R.D. 1972. Induction of early flowering in 'Carabao' mango in the Philippines by smudging and ethephon application. Hort.Science 7:343. FAO, 2009. Production Yearbook. Food and Agricultural Organization of the 139 140 United Nations, Rome. Gonzales, L.G.1923.The smudging of mango trees and its effects. Philipp.Agric.12:15-27. Hoda, M.N., Singh, S. and Singh, J., 2001, Effect of cultar on flowering, fruiting and fruit quality of mango cv. Langra. Indian J. Hort., 58 (3) : 224-227. Issarakraisila, M.J., J.A. Considine and D.W. Turner. 1991. Pattern of vegetative and reproductive growth of mango trees in a warm temperate region of Western Australia. Acta Hort. 291:188-197. James, M., D. Lennox, and L. Roberts-Nkruma. 1992. The effect of potassium nitrate and boron treatments on mango (cv. Tommy Atkins) flowering and fruit retention. IV International Mango Symposium, Miami, Florida, p. 81. Kulkarni, V. J. 1988. Chemical control of tree vigour and the promotion of flowering and fruiting in mango (Mangifera Indica L.) using paclobutrazol. J. Hort. Sci., 63 (3) 557-566. Kulkarni, V.J. 1991. Physiology of flowering in mango studied by grafting. Acta Hort. 291:95-104. Litz, R.E., 1997. The mango, Botany, Production and Uses. First ed., CAB International. Univ. Press, Cambridge, N.Y. pp: 587. Madamba, J.C.1978. The Philippines recommends for mango. Philippine Council for Agriculture and Resources Research. Mukherjee, S.K., 1951. Origin of Mango. Indian J. Genet. Pl. Breed., 11: 49–56. Mukherjee, S.K., 1967. Cytology and Breeding of Mango. Punjab Hort. J., 3: 107– 15. Mustard, M.J. and Lynch, S.J. 1946. Flower-bud formation and development in Mangifera indica. Bot. Gaz. 108:136-140. Nakasone, H T., Bowers, F A.I. and Beaumont, J. H. 1955. Terminal growth and flowering behaviour in the ‘Pairie’ mango in Hawaii. Proc. Amer. Soc. Hort. Sci., 66: 183-91. Nartvaranant P., Subhadrabandhu S. and Tongumpai P. 2000. Practical aspects in producing off-season mango in Thailand. Acta Horticulturae. 509: 661-668. 140 141 Nunez-Elisea R, Davenport TL (1992) Requirement for mature leaves during floral induction and floral transition in developing shoots of mango. Acta Hort. 296:33-37. Pal, R.N., Chadha, K.L. and M.R.K.Rao.1979. Effect of different plant growth regulators and other chemicals on flowering behaviour of mango paper presented at mango workers meeting held at Panji, Goa, May 2-5, 1979. Protacio, C.M. 2000. A model for potassium nitrate-induced flowering in mango. Acta Hort. 509: 545–552. Purseglove, J.W., 1972. Mangoes west of India. Acta Horticulturae, 24: 107–74. Reece, P.C, Furr, J.R and Cooper, W.C. 1946. The inhibiting effect of the terminal bud on flower formation in the axillary buds of the ‘Haden’ mango. Am. J. Bot. 33:209-210. Reece, P.C, Furr, J.R and Cooper, W.C. 1949. Further studies of floral induction in the Haden mango (Mangifera indica L.). Am. J. Bot. 36:734-740. Schaffer, B., Whiley, A.W., Crane, J.H. 1994. Mango. In: B. Schaffer and P.C. Anderson (eds). Hand book of Environmental physiology of Fruit Crops, Vol. II Subtropical and Tropical crops. CRC Press, Boca Raton, pp. 165-97. Scholefield, P.B., Oag, D.R., Sedgley, M., 1986. The relationship between vegetative and reproductive development in the mango in northern Australia. Aust. J. Agric. Res. 37, 425–433. Sen, P.C. and Mallik, P.C. 1941. The time of differentiation of flower buds of the mango. Indian J. Agric. Sci. 11: 74-81 Sen, P.C. and Mallik, P.C.1947. Effect of smudging on Mango. Indian J. Hort., 5 (2): 29-34. Sen, P.K. 1943. The bearing problem of mango and how to control it. Indian J. Hort. 1: 48-71. Li B., Xie Z., Zhang A., Xu W., Zhang C., Liu Q., Liu C., Wang S., 2010. Tree growth characteristics and flower bud differentiation of sweet cherry (Prunus avium L.) under different climate conditions in China. Hort. Sci. (Prague), 37: 6–13. Sen, P.K., M. Bandopadhyay, S.S.Roy and R.N.Basu. 1973. Use of ethrel in controlling non-uniform bearing of mango. Indian Agric.17:185-288. 141 142 Sen, S.P. 1951. The biochemical aspects of flowering. Bull. Bot. Soc. Bengal, 5(2). 57. Shinde, A.K., Waghmare, B.H., Waghand, R.G and Burondkar H.M., 2000, Effect of dose and time of paclobutrazol application on flowering and yield of mango. Indian J. Plant. Physiol., 5(1): 82-84. Singh, D.K. and Ram, S. (1998). Effect time of Paclobutrazol application in mango. Abstract book, National symposium on mango production and exports June. 25-27, Lucknow, pp.41. Singh, L.B. 1971. The mango; Botany, cultivation and utilization. Leonard Hill Ltd., London. Singh, R.N. 1958. Studies in the differentiation and development of fruit buds in mango. II-Morphological and histological changes, Hort.Adv., 2: 37. Singh, R.N. 1959. Studies in the differentiation and development of fruit bud in mango (Mangifera indica L.) varieties. III. Mango shoot and fruit-bud differentiation. Hort. Adv. 3: 28-49. Singh, R.N. 1960. Studies in the differentiation and development of fruit buds in mango (Mangifera indica L.). IV. Periodical changes in the chemical composition of shoots and their relation with fruit-bud-differentiation. Hort. Adv.4: 48-59. Singh, R.N. 1961. Studies in the differentiation and development of fruit buds in mango (Mangifera indica L.). V. Effect of defoliation, decapitation and deblossoming on fruit-bud differentiation. Indian J. Hort. 18: 1-11. Stafstrom, J.P. (1995). Developmental potential of shoot buds. Pages 257–279 in B. L. Gartner, ed. Plant Stems: Physiology and Functional Morphology. San Diego: Academic Press. Singh, R.N. 1971. Biennial bearing in fruit trees – Accent on mango and apple. Indian Council of Agri. Res. Tech. Bull.30: (New Delhi). pp. 47. Tandel, Y. N. and Patel, N. L.(2011). Effect of chemicals on growth, yield and economics of mango (Mangifera indica L.). Karnataka J. Agric. Sci., 24 (3):362 – 365. Wester, P.J. 1920. The mango. Philipp. Bur. Agric.Bull.18. Yeshitela, T., P. J. Robbertse and P. J. C. Stassen, 2004. Effects of various inductive 142 143 periods and chemicals on flowering and vegetative growth of ‘Tommy Atkins' and 'Keitt' mango (Mangifera indica) cultivars. New Zealand Journal of Crop and Horticultural Science. 32: 209-215. Yeshitela, T., P. J. Robbertse and P.J.C. Stassen. 2004. Paclobutrazol suppressed vegetative growth and improved yield as well as fruit quality of ‘Tommy Atkins’ mango (Mangifera indica) in Ethiopia. NZ J. Crop Hort. Sci.32: 281–293. Whiley, A.W., Rasmussen, T.S., Saranath, J.B. and Wolstenholme, B.N. 1989. Effect of temperature on growth, dry matter production and starch accumulation in ten mango (Mangifera Indica L.) cultivars J. Hort. Sci. 64: 753-65. 143 144 Journal of Today’s Biological Sciences: Research & Review (JTBSRR) ISSN 2320-1444 (Online) JTBSRR Vol.1, Issue 1, page 144-152, December 30, 2012 Available on: www.jtbsrr.in Basic and Applied Research in Soil Organic Matter Pratap V. Naikwade Department of Botany, Nya. Tyatyasahe Aathalye Arts, Ved. S. R. Sapre Commerce and Vid. Dadasaheb Pitre Science College, Devrukh-415804, Maharashtra, India. E- mail: naikwade.pratap@gmail.com Abstrct Plants obtain nutrients from two natural sources: organic matter and minerals. Organic matter includes any plant or animal material that returns to the soil and goes through the decomposition process. Majority of the soils in world are with less organic matter. Intensive tillage and agriculture met food production but resulted in sick infertile soil. Soil organic matter affects the chemical and physical properties of the soil and its overall health. Its composition and breakdown rate affect: the soil structure and porosity; the water infiltration rate and moisture holding capacity of soils; the diversity and biological activity of soil organisms; and plant nutrient availability.These attributes of organic matter lead it to have a major influence on the quality of soil material itself. As societies throughout the world begin to realize the potential value of the soil resource in contributing to sustainable farming practices, the need to understand the role that organic matter plays in contributing to soil quality has become more important. The present study deals with basic and applied research about soil organic matter which is not only related to agronomy and soil science but also to ecology. biochemistry, microbiology, biotechnology, biophysics, environmental science etc. It gives details about components, attributes, properties functions and management of soil organic matter. Key Words: organic matter, soil, basic, research, fertility Introduction As we enter the 21st century, pressure on the world’s ecosystems to provide for human needs is at an unprecedented level. It was estimated by Oldeman (1994) that by 1990, some 562 million hectares (38% of the world’s cropland) had been 144 145 degraded by poor agricultural practices. Further damage had occurred, with the annual degradation of 5–6 million hectares, and current trends are not encouraging. Losses in the organic matter content of soils during the last 100 years have been substantial, and have been associated with changing patterns of land use that are driven by population increases. The process of cultivation of native soils is nearly always associated with a loss of organic carbon, as previously protected organic matter is oxidized following exposure to the atmosphere (Davidson and Ackerman, 1993; Gregorich et al., 1998). It is likely that these losses were not evenly distributed across the globe, with disproportionately large losses from upland, organic and wetland soils. Losses of soil organic matter are also associated with land use change other than direct conversion to agriculture, such as deforestation and biomass burning (IPCC, 1996). Some analyses carried out in parts of Africa show that nutrients are being depleted at an alarming rate (Smaling et al., 1996). Nutrient budgets can be used at differing scales and, although associated with a high degree of spatial heterogeneity, they can be valuable in identifying regional trends. In Nigeria, Smaling et al. (1998) found that the difference between the input and output of N leads to an average net annual loss of 27 kg ha−1, in soils that in many cases are already nutrient poor. Shen et al. (1989) found that soils that had received an annual addition of 144 kg N ha−1 over 137 years contained more organic matter than those receiving no fertilizer additions. Components and Functions of soil Organic Matter Forms and classification of soil organic matter have been described by Tate (1987) and Theng (1987). For practical purposes, organic matter may be divided into aboveground and belowground fractions. Aboveground organic matter comprises plant residues and animal residues; belowground organic matter consists of living soil fauna and microflora, partially decomposed plant and animal residues, and humic substances (Bauer and Black, 1994). Although soil organic matter can be partitioned conveniently into different fractions, these do not represent static end products. Instead, the amounts present reflect a dynamic equilibrium. The total amount and partitioning of organic matter in the soil is influenced by soil properties and by the quantity of annual inputs of plant and animal residues to the ecosystem (Bell et al, 1998). Organic matter within the soil serves several functions. From a practical agricultural standpoint, it is important for two main reasons: (i) as a “revolving nutrient fund”; and (ii) as an agent to improve soil structure, maintain tilth and minimize erosion. Organic matter releases nutrients in a plant-available form upon decomposition (Hudson, 1994). In order to maintain this nutrient cycling system, the rate of organic matter addition from crop residues, manure and any 145 146 other sources must equal the rate of decomposition, and take into account the rate of uptake by plants and losses by leaching and erosion (Prasad and Pawar, 1997). Where the rate of addition is less than the rate of decomposition, soil organic matter declines. Conversely, where the rate of addition is higher than the rate of decomposition, soil organic matter increases (Lavelle and Spain, 2001). In terms of improving soil structure, the active and some of the resistant soil organic components, together with micro-organisms (especially fungi), are involved in binding soil particles into larger aggregates. Aggregation is important for good soil structure, aeration, water infiltration and resistance to erosion and crusting. Traditionally, soil aggregation has been linked with either total C (Matson et al., 1997) or organic C levels (Dalal and Mayer, 1986a, 1986b). More recently, techniques have developed to fractionate C on the basis of lability (ease of oxidation), recognizing that these subpools of C may have greater effect on soil physical stability and be more sensitive indicators than total C values of carbon dynamics in agricultural systems (Blair and Crocker, 2000). At the agro ecosystem, or ‘field’ scale, organic matter influences many readily measurable soil functions or processes (Schnitzer, 1991). Organic matter is both a source and a sink for plant nutrients, and provides an energy substrate for soil organisms. Soil macro- and micro aggregation that aid the infiltration of air and water, are promoted and stabilized by soil organic matter (Tisdall, 1996). Organic matter promotes water retention and influences the efficacy and fate of applied pesticides (Gregorich et al., 1994, 1997). It also influences certain soil physical processes such as compactibility (Soane, 1990), friability (Watts and Dexter, 1998) and the range of soil ‘available’ water for plant growth (Kay, 1998). Overall, the positive interrelationship between soil organic matter and soil aggregation has important benefits on both water and air infiltration, soil erodibility and conservation of organic matter and nutrients (Feller and Beare, 1997). Soil organic matter properties and attributes Gregorich et al. (1994) indicated that soil organic matter should be viewed as a set of fractions rather than a single entity. These fractions are descriptive of the ‘quality’ of soil organic matter. Important fractions of organic matter are the light fraction, macro organic matter (i.e. particulate carbon), microbial biomass carbon, mineralizable carbon, carbohydrates and enzymes. These fractions have biological significance as they are involved in several soil functions and processes such as aggregation and formation of soil structure, and nutrient cycling and storage. Chemical characterization of organic matter, that provides information on chemical structure and functional groups, is also useful to evaluate the influence of land use changes on organic matter (Monreal et al., 1995). However, the utility of such measurements in soil quality evaluation is not 146 147 so clear. Measurements of soil biota abundance, diversity or activity are considered potential indicators of soil quality (Gregorich et al., 1997). The microbial biomass is the main agent that supports the soil function and associated processes involved with the storing and cycling of nutrients and energy (Carter et al., 1999). Mycorrhizal fungi play an important role in sustainable plant productivity and in the formation and maintenance of soil structural stability (Tisdall, 1996), while soil fauna are major determinants of soil processes influencing nutrient cycling, aggregate formation and permeability of soil (Lavelle et al., 1997). Managing soil organic matter The maintenance of organic matter for the sake of maintenance alone is not a practical approach to farming. It is more realistic to use a management system that will give sustained, profitable production (caligeri et al, 1998). The greatest source of soil organic matter is the residue contributed by current crops. Consequently, crop yield and type, method of handling residues and frequency of fallow are all important factors. Ultimately, soil organic matter must be maintained at a level necessary to maintain soil tilth (Paustian, 2002). Depletion of soil fertility due to less organic matter is a major constraint for higher crop production in not only India but other parts of world. Most of the cultivated soils have organic matter of below 1.5 % and on the other hand, addition of organic matter is very low. Almost all farmers are relying on chemical fertilizers to remove nutrient deficiency for profitable yields (Tate, 1987). Consequently little or no accumulation of organic matter occurs in soil. A suitable combination of organic and inorganic sources of nutrients is necessary for sustainable crop yields. Nambiar (1997) reported that integrated use of organic manure and chemical fertilizers would be promising not only in providing greater stability in production, but also maintaining better soil fertility status. A long-term research revealed that the application of dung manure at 5 t ha-1 y-1 improved soil resources from degradation (Bhuiyan et al. 1994). Application of organic materials alone or in combination with inorganic fertilizer helped in proper nutrition and maintenance of soil fertility (Salim et al., 1988; Talashiker and Rinal, 1986). Hussain et al. (1988) reported that organic manures increased the efficiency of chemical fertilizers. Beneficial effects of farm yard manure on crop production through improved fertility and physical properties of soil is an established fact (Singh and Sarivastore, 1971). Soil organic matter, N, sulfur (S), and P generally increase immediately after compost addition because of an increased supply of organic C (Smith, 1991). This stimulating effect can last a few months, depending on the quantity and quality 147 148 of the amended compost and nutrient availability in the soil (Perucci, 1990). Microbial biomassis considered the most active fraction of soil organic matter and represents a significant source of plant-available nutrients (Smith and Paul, 1991). The increased total microbial biomass and enzyme activity due to compost amendments can improve soil fertility over a long time. the fertility of soils is often tied to their organic matter content (Brady, 1974). Buchanan and Gliessman (1990) concluded that organic matter additions by compost, combined with inorganic N or P fertilizer. Onion (Allium cepa L.) yield on a sandy loam soil increased with increasing rate of organic matter application, when the organic matter was biosolids/straw compost or digested or raw biosolids (Smith et al., 1992). Application of organic materials reduced soil acidity and improved organic matter and available nutrients of the soil. (Sanwal et. al., 2007), Singh et al. (2007) proved that Sugarcane crop responded well to different organic manures in a multiple ratooning system with a better economic output and improved soil quality. The application of farm yard manure, poultry manure and sugarcane filter cake alone or in combination with chemical fertilizers improved the soil organic C, total N, P, and K status. (Kulvinder Kaur et al.,2008). An experiment was carried out to compare organic Manures and Chemical Fertilizers on Saffron (Crocus sativus L.) cultivation. Application of organic manure by green manure, compost, vermicompost improved soil fertility (Amiri, 2009). Results and Discussions The tension between natural resource and economic sustainability in agroecosystems, which has important consequences for conservation of soil organic matter, underlines the need to develop strategies for increasing soil organic matter by addition of humus rich contents like organic manures. Soil organic matter is derived from once-living plant or animal matter. It includes leaves, weeds, and animal waste. Organic matter may be one man’s trash, but to the nursery, it is a treasure. Soil organic matter can greatly improve the substrate’s chemical and physical properties necessary for good plant growth. It provides plant nutrients, improves porosity and water-holding capacity, and makes the substrate lighter and easier to transport. The functioning of soils is profoundly influenced by their organic matter content. The abilities of a soil to supply nutrients, store water, release greenhouse gases, modify pollutants, resist physical degradation and produce crops within a sustainably managed framework are all strongly affected by the quality and quantity of the organic matter that it contains. Basic and applied research about soil organic matter which is not only related to agronomy and soil science but also to ecology. biochemistry, microbiology, biotechnology, biophysics, environmental science etc and hence greatly important. 148 149 References Amiri, Mohammad E., 2009. Comparison of animal Manures and Chemical Fertilizers on Saffron (Crocus sativus L.) cultivation. UC Davis: The Proceedings of the International Plant Nutrition Colloquium XVI. Bauer, A. and Black, A.L., 1994. Quantification of the effect of soil organic matter content on soil productivity. Am. J. Soil Sci. Soc., 5: 185-193. Bell, M.J., Moody, P.W., Connolly, R.D. and Bridge, B.J., 1998. The role of active fractions of soil organic matter in physical and chemical fertility of Ferrosols. Aust. J. Soil Res., 36: 809-819. Bhuiyan, H.I., 1994. Crop production trends and need of sustainability in agriculture. Paper presented at the Workshop, Integrated Nutrient Management for Sustainable Agriculture, held at Dhaka, Bangladesh. Blair, N. and Crocker, G.J., 2000. Crop rotation effects on soil carbon and physical fertility of two Australian soils. Aust. J. Soil Res., 38: 71-84. Brady, N.C., 1974. The Nature and Properties of Soils. 8th edition. Macmillan Publishing Company, New York, 99. Buchanan, M. A. and Gliessman, S. R., 1990. The influence of conventional and compost fertilization on phosphorus use efficiency by broccoli in a phosphorus deficient soil. American Journal of Alternative Agriculture 5: 38-46. Calegari, A., Darolt, M.R. and Ferro, M., 1998. Towards sustainable agriculture with a no-tillage system. Adv. Geo. Ecol., 31: 1205-1209 Carter, M.R., Gregorich, E.G., Angers, D.A., Beare, M.H., Sparling, G.P., Wardle, D.A. and Voroney, R.P., 1999. Interpretation of microbial biomass measurements for soil quality assessment in humid temperate regions. Canadian Journal of Soil Science, 79, 507–520. Dalal, R.C. and Mayer, R.J., 1986a. Long-term trends in fertility of soils under continuous cultivation and cereal cropping in Southern Queensland. I. Overall changes in soil properties and trends in winter cereal yields. Aust. J. Soil Res., 24, 265-279. Dalal, R.C. and Mayer, R.J., 1986b. Long-term trends in fertility of soils under continuous cultivation and cereal cropping in Southern Queensland. II. Total organic carbon and its rate of loss from the soil profile. Aust. J. Soil Res., 24, 281292. 149 150 Davidson, E.A. and Ackerman, I.L., 1993. Changes in soil carbon inventories following cultivation of previously untilled soils. Biogeochemistr, 20,161–193. Feller, C. and Beare, M.H., 1997. Physical control of soil organic matter dynamics in the tropics. Geoderma 79, 69–116. Gregorich, E.G., Carter, M.R., Angers, D.A., Monreal, C.M. and Ellert, B.H., 1994. Towards a minimum data set to assess soil organic matter quality in agricultural soils. Canadian Journal of Soil Science,74, 367–385. Gregorich, E.G., Carter, M.R., Doran, J.W., Pankhurst, C.E. and Dwyer, L.M., 1997. Biological attributes of soil quality. In: Gregorich, E.G. and Carter,M.R. (eds) Soil Quality for Crop Production and Ecosystem Health. Elsevier,Amsterdam, The Netherlands, 81–113. Gregorich, E.G., Greer, K.J., Anderson, D.W. and Liang, B.C., 1998. Carbon distribution and losses: erosion and deposition effects. Soil and Tillage Research, 47, 291–302. Hudson, B.D., 1994. Soil organic matter and available water capacity. J. Soil Wat. Con., 49(2): 189-194. Hussain, T. Jullani G. and Iqbal. M.Z., 1988. Integrated use of organic and inorganic N fertilizer in ricewheat cropping system. Pak. J. Soil Sci. 3:19- 23. Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change, 1996. Climate change 1995: impacts, adaptations and mitigation of climate change. In: Watson, R.T., Zinyowera, M.C. and Moss, R.C. (eds) Cambridge University Press, Cambridge,745–772. Kay, B.D., 1998. Soil structure and organic carbon: a review. In: Lal, R., Kimble, J.M., Follett, R.F. and Stewart, B.A. (eds) Soil Processes and the Carbon Cycle. CRC Press, Boca Raton, Florida, 169–197. Kulvinder Kaur, Goyal S. and Kapoor K. K., 2008. Impact of organic fertilizers with and without chemical fertilizers on soil chemical properties and the establishment of nitrogen fixing bacteria in rhizosphere, Microbes Enviorn. 23 (4):313-316. Lavelle, P. and Spain, A., 200. Soil ecology. Dordrecht, The Netherlands, Kluwer Academic Publishers. Lavelle, P., Bignell, D., LePage, M., Wolters, V., Roger, P., Ineson, P., Heal, O.W. 150 151 and Dhillion, S., 1997. Soil function in a changing world: the role of invertebrate ecosystem engineers. European Journal of Soil Biology,33, 159–193. Matson, P.A., Parton, W.J., Power, A.G. and Swift, M.J., 1997. Agricultural intensification and ecosystem properties. Science, 277: 504-509. Monreal, C.M., Gregorich, E.G., Schnitzer, M. and Anderson, D.W.,1995. The quality of soil organic matter as characterized by soilid CPMAS 13C-NMR and Py-FIMS. In: Huang, P.M. et al. (eds) Environmental Impact of Soil Component Interactions, Vol. 1. Lewis Publishers, CRC Press, Boca Raton, Florida, 207–215. Nambiar, K.K.M., 1997. Soil health and organic matter: Changing scenario. Proc. Nat. ACAD. Sci. India Spl. Issue, 141-160. Oldeman, L.R., 1994, Soil Resilience and Sustainable Land Use. CAB International, Oxford University Press, New York. Paustian, K., 2002. Organic matter and global cycle. In: Encyclopedia of soil science, 895-898. New York, USA, Marcel Dekker Inc. Perucci, P., 1990. Effect of the addition of municipal solid waste compost on microbial biomass and enzyme activities in soils. Biology and Fertility of Soils 10:221–226. Prasad, R. and Power, J.F., 1997. Soil fertility management for sustainable agriculture. New York, USA, Lewis Publishers. 356. Salim, M., Mian S.M. and Mahmoodul Hassan., 1988.Annual technical report of project improvement of soil productivity through biological mean. Pak. Agric. Res. Council, Islamabad. Sanwal, S.K., Lakminarayana, K., Yadav, R.K., Rai, N., Yadav, D.S. and Mousumi, B., 2007. Effect of organic manures on soil fertility, growth, physiology, yield and quality of turmeric. Indian J. Hort., 64(4): 444-449. Schnitzer, M., 1991 Soil organic matter – the next 75 years. Soil Science 151,41-58. Shen, S.M.P., Hart, B.S., Powlson, D.S. and Jenkinson, D.S., 1989. The nitrogencycle in the Broadbalk wheat experiment – 15N labelled fertilizer residues in the soil and in the soil microbial biomass. Soil Biology and Biochemistry,21, 529–533. Singh, K. and Sarivastore., 1971. Effect of organic manure in Soil fertility as shown by nutrient availability and crop yield response in Potato New Pro. Symp. 151 152 on soil evaluation, New Delhi. Singh, K. P.,Suman A.,Singh, P.N. and Lal, M., 2007. Yield and soil nutrient balance of a sugarcane plant-ratoon system with conventional and organic nutrient management in sub-tropical India. Nutr Cycl Agroecosyst,79:209-219. Smaling, E.M.A., Fresco, L.O. and deJager, A., 1996. Classifying, monitoring and improving soil nutrient stacks and flows in African agriculture. Ambio 25, 492– 496. Smaling, E.M.A., Nandura, S.M. and Janssen, B.H., 1998. Soil fertility in Africa is at stake. In: Buresh, R., Sanchez, P. and Calhoun, F. (eds) Replenishing Soil Fertility in Africa. Soil Science Society of America, Wisconsin, 47–61. Smith, J.L. and Paul, E.A., 1991. The significance of soil microbial biomass estimations, p. 359–396. In: J.J. Bollag and G. Stotzky (eds.). Soil Biochemistry. 6. Marcel Dekker, New York. Smith, R.S., 1991. Effects of sewage sludge application on soil microbial processes and soil fertility, p. 191–212. In: B.A. Stewart (ed.). Advances in Soil Science. 16. Springer-Verlag, New York. Smith, R.S., Hall J.E., and Hadley P., 1992. Composting sewage sludge wastes in relation to their suitability for use as fertilizer materials for vegetable crop production. Acta Horticulturae 302: 203–215. Soane, B.D., 1990. The role of organic matter in soil compactibility: a review of some practical aspects. Soil and Tillage Research, 16, 179–201. Talashiker, S.C. and Rinal O.P., 1986. Studies on increasing in combination with city solid waste. J. India Soc. Soil Sci. 34:780-784. Tate, R.L., 1987. Soil organic matter: biological and ecological effects. New York, USA, John Wiley & Sons. Tisdall, J.M., 1996. Formation of soil aggregates and accumulation of soil organic matter. In: Carter, M.R. and Stewart, D.A. (eds) Structure and Organic Matter Storage in Agricultural Soils. Lewis Publishers, CRC Press, Boca Raton, Florida, 57–96. Watts, C.W. and Dexter, A.R., 1998. Soil friability: theory, measurement and the effects of management and organic carbon content. European Journal of Soil Science 49, 73–84. 152 153 Journal of Today’s Biological Sciences: Research & Review (JTBSRR) ISSN 2320-1444 (Online) JTBSRR Vol.1, Issue 1, page 153-159, December 30, 2012 Available on: www.jtbsrr.in Application of Telemedicine Overview in India -- An Subhasis Bandyopadhyay Institute of Computer and Information Science, Bankura,West Bengal, India E-mail: subhasis_ban83@yahoo.co.in Abstract India got an opportunity to make its health infrastructure better with its faster growing information and communication technology. With implementation of Telemedicine, it can serve weakly served or un served parts of country. Telemedicine uses some modern information and communication techniques to connect distant part of world. By application of it countries like India can make drastic change in their health structure by milking its advantages. They can serve cheap but world class medical facilities and education to rural parts of country (as most ill served part of India is villages).But to implement it India may face some challenges. It have to overcome those challenges and implement it with help of Government bodies (like Indian Space Research Organization), Govt. executives and private players working together. Key Words: Telemedicine, Health, Medical facility Introduction Telemedicine is a boon of modern information and communication system. It is a process of connecting healthcare system of one part of world with other parts for exchanging consultancies, education some other healthcare facilities with a view of betterment of world’s health infrastructure. Here ‘Tele’ is a Greek word which means ‘Distance’ and ‘Mederi’ is a Latin word which means ‘to heal’. So Times magazine has described this system as ‘Healing by wire’. World health 153 154 organization has defined Telemedicine as--- “The delivery of healthcare services, where distance is a critical factor, by all healthcare professionals using information and communication technologies for the exchange of valid information for diagnosis, treatment and prevention of disease and injuries, research and evaluation, and for continuing education of healthcare providers, all in the interest of advancing the health of individuals and their communities.” India also has come up with Telemedicine technology with a plane of connecting excellent healthcare facilities of specialty hospitals with rural hospitals. There are several types of Telemedicine facilities. These are – 1. Telenpathology: Images and videos can be transmitted as a computerized file and thus job of pathologist can be made easy. 2. Telesurgery: by use of multiple high resolution video camera doctors can get three dimensional views. Medical students also can do dissection using visuals on internet. 3. Telecardiology: In telecardiology, Electrocardiographs (EGCs0 can be transmitted using information and communication technologies. Methodology Application of Telemedicine in India to cover it’s under developed rural healthcare facilities is discussed here with some case studies. Reliable secondary data and some case studies are used to analyze the applications of Telemedicine with giving a trace on Indian villages. Technologies used in Telemedicine Growth of Information and communication technologies is the reason of boom of Telemedicine world wide. There are several technologies used to transmit image and video files from one place to other. These are – 1. Stored and forward method: In this process digital image is taken and stored. Then the image is forwarded to another location. Diagnosis and / or consultation information are sent back. 2. Video Conferencing: through televisions. Two way interactive communications is made 154 155 3. Integrated services digital Network (ISDN), a high-speed international communication standard for transmitting video, audio and data over digital or normal telephone wires. 4. T-1 is another technology used to transmit voice and digital data at 1.554 megabyte per second(mbps) 5. Plain old telephone service also used for audio conferencing, storing and forwarding data and low bandwidth video conferencing. 6. Internet is also used for telemedicine services. Several hospitals have their own website providing information and consultancies. Application of telemedicine in India Out of total 1210.2 million populations in India, 833.1(68.84%) million population resides in rural India. This 68.84% of rural population lack the basic medical facilities. According to a report of rural health statistics (RHS), 2010, there is a shortage of 19,590 sub centers, 4252 primary health centers and 2115 community health centers in India. Beside this crude birth rate (defined as the number of live births per 1000 persons over a period of one year.) in rural India has also declined from 38.9 per thousand in 1971 to 23.7 per thousand in 2010. According to Indian Institute of public opinion, that 89% of rural Indian patients have to travel near about 8 km for accessing basic medical facilities. In another report of Indian medical society has informed that 75% of qualified doctors are practicing in urban areas, 23% in semi urban areas and only 2% in rural health centers. This all shows the poor infrastructure of rural India and the need of introduction of Information and communication technologies like Telemedicine in India. Telemedicine can provide world class medical facilities of specialty hospital to the hospitals of remote areas and thus can reduce the cost of treatment there. Telemedicine can make medical facilities accessible to all rural Indian families. In Indian telemedicine reform, Indian space research organization (ISRO) has played a vital role. It has come up with satellite bandwidth, soft wares and hard wares. ISRO has set up Health SAT, a satellite, to provide telemedicine facilities to rural people of India. According to L.S. Sathyamurthy, Program director of Telemedicine at ISRO “There are 650 district hospitals, 3000 taluk(sub district)hospitals and more than 23000 primary health centers in the country, we must aim to connect all these phases. First district hospitals connected to specialty hospitals in major cities, then taluk level hospitals, and finally primary health centers, so that nobody, irrespective of his location, is deprived of lifesaving specialty consultation.” In the goal of doing that, ISRO has run a pilot 155 156 project in 2001 and connected 60 remote hospitals with 20 super specialty hospitals. India has efficiently applied Telemedicine in several hospitals of it and has got a good result. Till now Indian Telemedicine network has done efficiently well by treating more than 25000 patient and proving Telemedicine facilities to 100 of hospitals(ISRO has connected 78 rural/remote/district health centers with 22 specialty hospitals of major cities. In an telemedicine project, G.B.Pant hospital at port blair has connected with shri Ramchandra medical college and research institute, Chennai. In another project, Narayana Hrudayalaya of Karnataka is linked with Chamaraynagar and Vivekananda memorial hospital,d district hospital of Sagar by Telemedicine facilities. According to Amrita Telemedicine Programme’s report, 13 th January 2003, they has performed first remote Telesurgery to save a pilgrim using local Telemedicine facility. Besides them Apollo group also has successfully implemented Telemedicine facilities in India. A Case Study of Apollo Group Apollo hospital has introduced Telemedicine with a mission of spreading standard healthcare facilities in the reach of every individual of India and world. In voice of Dr. Prathap C. Reddy (Founder and Chairman, Apollo Hospitals Group), “Our mission is to bring healthcare of international standards within the reach of every individual. We are committed to the achievement and maintenance of excellence in education, research and healthcare for the benefit of humanity”. In the aim of introducing Telemedicine in India, Apollo group has introduced Apollo Telemedicine Networking foundation (ATNF), non profit organization. Today ATNF has 125 peripheral centers including 10 overseas. Besides, ATNF providing telemedicine facilities in the distance ranging 200 to 75000 km with its 75000 teleconsultation in 25 different disciplines. Ministry of external affair had selected ATNF for providing teleconsultation and tele education to 53 countries of African union. In the 12 year journey of ATNF, It has done remarkably well to cover several parts of country and 29 African countries. World healthcare congress, Washington, USA has awarded ATNF with the BEST POSTER AWARD in April, 2011. 156 157 Challenges Faced Telemedicine By India in Introduction of Poor infrastructure and lack of knowledge of computer in rural India has made task of implementation of Telemedicine very challenging. Several type of problems faced in implementation of Telemedicine in India. These are— 1. There are lack of infrastructure in rural india.Several villages still have no electricity. Though Rajiv Gandhi Gramin Vidyutikaran Yojana (RGGVY) has introduced as a remedy of that problem by providing connection to all villages and free connection to BPL families. 2. There is a fear of losing job if this technology is introduced. 3. Due to lack of knowledge and expertise in handling information technology and other equipments, people hesitate to use Telemedicine. 4. Some people think that setting up of telemedicine facilities will incur high initial investment. So it is not financially viable. 5. Doctors even sometimes are not fully convinced or familiar with this technology. 6. There are only few people who know English. So, Language barrier is a big challenge in India. Benefits of using telemedicine Telemedicine is like a magic to Indian healthcare infrastructure which can make drastic change in rural healthcare practice by bringing world class medical facilities to remote and rural villages. People who are suffer of poor rural healthcare facilities in India, will be able to access those facilities at their door step. Besides this, Telemedicine also possesses several other benefits. These are -1. Telemedicine provides cost effective medical services. 2. Telemedicine is used in optimization of resources. 3. It can provide specialist advice and counseling via use of information and communication technologies at patient’s home or nearest possible site eliminating need of unnecessary travelling. 157 158 4. Telemedicine helps in providing healthcare facilities at remote villages. 5. Telemedicine is very helpful for medical professional in exchanging information and consultation. 6. Telemedicine can be used to save life of injured people at war or disaster effected areas. 7. Telemedicine is also help in the education of medical healthcare professionals Conclusion With a bird’s eye view of improving healthcare system in India, Telemedicine emerging in this subcontinent in jet speed. Govt. body (like ISRO, department of information technology of ministry of communication and information technology etc.) and private players have come up with efforts in implementation of telemedicine. Now India is able to milk their opportunity to cover its weak health infrastructure with the boon of faster growing information technology dream of Healthy India will come in reality. References Websites http://www.telemedicineindia.com/ http://www.isro.org/publications/pdf/Telemedicine.pdf http://telemed.esanjeevani.in/Telemedicine/Report.pdf Others Bachi S. (2006) Telemedicine in rural India, PLoS Med 3(3): e82 doi : 101371/ Journal pmed -0030082, march 2006 Berdusis K., Tele echocardiography and Tele cardiology, Telemedicine Today, June 1999. Deb Soumya, 2008, Telemedicine – a new horizon in public health in India, Indian J community Med , January,2008, 33(1):3-8 doi – 10.4103/0970-218.39234 158 159 Hazra Anupam,2012, Development – Demography of rural India, Kurukshetra, Vol. 60 No. 9, July 2012 Kohil Seema, 2012, Telemedicine – an overview, Pharmatimes, Vol. 36, No.7, July 2004. Mundrey K. Telemedicine : The new frontier, Information systems computer world, June 1998 Report of technical working group for telemedicine standardization, department of information technology(DIT),Ministry of communication and information technology(MCIT),2003, 159 160 Journal of Today’s Biological Sciences: Research & Review (JTBSRR) ISSN 2320-1444 (Online) JTBSRR Vol.1, Issue 1, page 160-190, December 30, 2012 Available on: www.jtbsrr.in Eutrophication: Causative factors and remedial measures T.K.Ghosh1* and Debashri Mondal2 1Ultratech Environmental Consultancy and Laboratory, Survey no. 87, office 7 and 8, Bandal Prestige (in front of Siddhi Vinayak Mandir), Azad Nagar, Kothrud, Pune-411 038, E. mail- tkghosh@ultratech.in 2Dept.of Zoology, Raiganj Surendranath Mahavidyalaya, University of Gour Banga, Raiganj- 733134, West Bengal, India ,e. mail- debashri_mondal@rediffmail.com * Address for correspondence Abstract Eutrophication represents the aging process of lakes, whereby external or allochthonous sources of nutrients and organic matter of terrestrial origin accumulate in a lake basin, gradually decreasing its depth and increasing autochthonous production, to the point that the lake begins to take on a marsh-like character and, ultimately, a terrestrial character. Human influences in a drainage basin can greatly accelerate this enrichment process. Eutrophic lakes are normally more productive, less deep and exhibit reduced hypolimnetic oxygen concentrations during summer stratification. Indicator species (e.g. Chironomus) tends to dominate such waters, mainly because of their ability to tolerate typically lower oxygen concentrations. Diversity of phytoplankton, zooplankton, insects, fish and benthos clearly indicate trophic status of the water bodies. Also, Secchi disc transparency, chlorophyll-a level and P concentration of water denotes degree of eutrophication. Excessive P loading has been shown to promote potentially toxic nitrogen fixing genera, while excessive P and N loading can stimulate toxic blooms of non-N2 fixing genera (Microcystis, Lyngbya, Planktothrix). From a supply standpoint, both the absolute amounts and relative proportions of these nutrients play important roles in determining the composition, magnitude, and duration of Cyanobacterial Harmful Algal Blooms. In order to combat eutrophication, various remedial measures, commonly followed elsewhere, and select success stories around the world have been discussed. 160 161 Key Words: Eutrophication, nutrients, allochthonous, autochthonous, phosphorus, nitrogen, algal bloom, remedial measures Introduction Preamble The term "eutrophication" actually comes from a Greek word meaning "overfed." This is essentially what happens to a water body when it begins its journey down the road of dreadful condition. It is "overfed" to the point that it cannot handle all of the elements flowing into it, and if the trend is allowed to continue it eventually becomes eutrophic - a dead ecosystem. According to the Organization for Economic Cooperation and Development (OECD) 1982, eutrophication refers to the excessive nutrients enrichment of water which results in the stimulation of an array of undesirable symptomatic changes, such as nuisance production of algae and other aquatic macrophytes (plants), deterioration of water quality, taste & odour problems and fish kills. Each of these changes significantly interferes with human use of water resources. Eutrophication involves the enrichment of waters chiefly by increasing the levels of essential nutrients, such as Phosphates, Nitrates and Silicates (Lee et al. 1980; Uhllmann 1984). One of the hardest problems to overcome with this is that there are so many possible sources for these nutrients to get into the aquatic ecosystems - fertilizers, street runoff, animal excrement, and organic debris (such as leaves) just to name a few. As a result of this nutrient build-up, plant life (especially algae) begins to form in abundance. If the build-up of nutrients is severe enough, the algal blooms will cover the entire surface of the water and not allow any sunlight to penetrate the water column. This then creates a couple of consequences: 1) it prevents photosynthesis from occurring below the surface of the water, lowering the dissolved oxygen content of the water, and 2) stops oxygen transfer from occurring through surface aeration. Consequently the water body becomes extremely depleted of oxygen and sunlight, which causes fish and plant life alike to suffer. When fish and plants begin to die off, decomposing bacteria use the remaining oxygen to break down the dead organic compounds. The result is a body of water covered in algae, lacking in aquatic life and oxygen, both of which are necessary to promote a healthy aquatic ecosystem. In India, it has been assessed that more than 80 per cent of the total pollution load arises from domestic sources, such as domestic wastewater, which is 161 162 reported to contain P between 6 and 10 mg l-1 (Horan 1990). Per capita consumption of detergents in India in 1994 was 2.8 kg per annum, which was moved up to over 4 kg/capita by 2007. However, in rural areas the use of detergents is expected to grow 7-8 per cent annually. The figures are alarming because high quality detergents comprise around 35 per cent sodium tripolyphosphate (STPP). In India majority of detergents are triphosphate based, as its use enhances the cleaning property by sequestering the ions (Ca2+ and Mg2+) that cause water hardness. The impact of increased use of phosphate-based detergents on the growth of aquatic plants and cyanobacteria is well emphasized by Campbell (1987). In recent years, there has been an increasing awareness on the part of both scientists and the general public, of problems associated with excessive growth of the aquatic plants, particularly in lakes. Lake is a potential source of drinking water supply and about 4/5th of the total water supply comes from lakes. As such excessive growth of aquatic plants and algae, even in lakes with protected catchment area, assumes critical importance. Among the important adverse effects are health hazards to human and animal populations using such water bodies as a source of potable water. Eutrophication is the natural ageing process of lakes. It is characterized by a geologically slow shift from in-lake biological production driven by allochthonous (external to the water body) loading of nutrients, to production driven by autochthonous (in-lake) processes. This shift typically is accompanied by changes in species and biotic community composition, as an aquatic ecosystem is ultimately transformed into a terrestrial biome. In the process of eutrophication by natural aging, a lake will be slowly filled in with soil and other materials carried by inflowing waters, and eventually become a marsh and ultimately, a terrestrial system (Fig.1). This process usually takes many hundreds and thousands of years to occur and is largely irreversible. Lakes undergoing such natural eutrophication generally have good water quality and exhibit a diverse biological community throughout much of their existence. Eutrophication is a worldwide issue. It is often most severe in shallow lakes which are heavily influenced by large external nutrient loads, frequent sediment resuspension and resultant high turbidity, highly active sediment-water column nutrient exchange and nutrient regeneration. In response to nutrient enrichment, these lakes experience accelerated eutrophication, causing the ecosystem to shift from macrophyte to phytoplankton-dominated conditions, often culminating in summer cyanobacterial blooms. 162 163 Fig.1. Fate of organic pollutants in aquatic ecosystem In the area where there is no human settlement, the growth of algae and other aquatic plants in a lake in the drainage basin is usually minimal, and generally in balance with the input of plant nutrients. However, human settlements in a drainage basin and associated cleaning of forests for development of farms and cities etc., usually changes the natural eutrophication in a dramatic way. The runoff of the most materials from the land surface to the water body is greatly accelerated. An increased input of plant nutrients (mainly Phosphorus and Nitrogen) to a lake or reservoir can stimulate algal and aquatic plant growth, which in turn, can stimulate the growth of fish and other higher tropic level organisms in the aquatic food chain. The latter phenomenon is termed cultural eutrophication to distinguish it from the natural process (the terms ‘artificial’ and ‘anthropogenic’ or ‘man-made’ are also often used to describe the same phenomenon). The rate of this cultural eutrophication is enhanced by human/anthropogenic activities such as discharge of effluent from industries, domestic wastes, as well as point and non point sources from agricultural fields. 163 164 Consequence of eutrophication Excessive growth of algae and aquatic plants, which interfere with the uses and aesthetic quality of water body. Production of taste and odour in drinking water caused by the excessive growth of algae and aquatic plants. As algal populations die and sink to the bottom of a water body, their decay by bacteria can reduce oxygen concentrations in bottom waters to levels which are too low to support fish life resulting in fish kills. Owing to this oxygen deficit there is an excessive increase of Iron and Manganese in the water and this can interfere with the drinking water treatment. Also excess growth of algae results in clogging of filters in the treatment plants. There are also negative potential health effects especially in the tropical regions related to diseases like schistosomiasis, onchocerchiasis and malaria, all of which can be aggravated by cultural eutrophication, which can enhance the appropriate habitats for the causative organisms. Eutrophication and its effect on water Body The very large number of criteria used for the trophic state determination has contributed a lot to the belief that the trophic concept is multidimensional and involves a variety of parameters as represented in following Table 1. Table 1: Parameters for Determination of the Trophic State of a Lake Parameter Oligotrophic Eutrophic Occurrence of algal bloom Rare Frequent Frequency of green and Low blue green algae High Daily migration of algae Considerable Limited Characteristic algal groups Bacillariophyceae e.g. Pinnularia, Cymbella, Cyanophyceae Chlrophyceae e.g. Volvox, Microcystis, Nostoc Chrysophyceae e.g. Synura, Chromulina 164 e.g. 165 Represented by large size Characteristic zooplankton Represented by small size species e.g. Cyclops, groups species e.g. protozoans Daphnids Density of plankton Low High Characteristic of fish Finer variety of fish Course fish Depth Deeper Shallower Present Absent Algae High species diversity with low density and productivity often dominated by Chlorophyceae Low species diversity with high density and the productivity often dominated by Cyanophyceae Blooms Rare Frequent Plant nutrient flux Low High Animal production Low High Fish Finer variety of flux (e.g. Course fish carps) breathers Summer oxygen hypolimnion in e.g. Algal blooms Although nutrient status of a particular water body remains variable, but, occasionally a particular species becomes dominant leading to growth of ‘water bloom.’ A water bloom can be defined as dense growth of microscopic organisms in water, making water odiferous, unpleasant in taste or may turn it toxic during their growth cycle. It may be induced suddenly due to heavy rainfall or rise in solar radiation of temperature. Terrestrial plants, when submerged under water for long time, die and decompose within the lake making water odiferous. The microflora like diatoms and other algae form a source of food supply for various animals, directly or indirectly. Their occurrence may turn troublesome due to decomposition (Abeliovich and Shilo 1972). There are instances of coloured water in history which was recorded due to the colour and high density of the organisms like dinoflagellates, cyanobacteria or other algae. The ‘Red sea’ named after a marine red bloom (redtide), caused by a cyanobacterium ‘Trichodesmium erythreum’, resulted in massive fish-kills and varieties of cyanobacteria were also found to cause giddiness, convulsions and deaths of animals drinking fresh water. Many a time water 165 air 166 blooms are harmless, natural and go unnoticed; but when dense and continuous become catastrophic; if not accompanied by growth predatory species of fish and tiny crustaceans, e.g., Daphnia. Much interest has been generated on the toxins produced, especially by cyanobacteria, as they are potentially dangerous to domestic animals and to public safety. Toxicity studies with certain algal extracts to vertebrates and mice were found to be apparently possessing harmless chemicals, e.g., geosmin, which is produced when living matter including algal sludge decomposes, or by living Anabaena circinalis (Walsby 1975, Oliver 1994). The blooms occur when ideal conditions for growth of algae exist into aquatic environment. A correct balance of nutrients, ideal temperature and carbon-dioxide causes good growth of algae. At elevated temperatures nutrients are released more rapidly and bacteria as well as other microbes become more active in spring and summer; decomposing organic materials and reproducing faster than their competitors or predators. So, blooms are abundant in springs; when algae utilize nutrients and exhibit explosive growth and their number may increase one thousand times from normal. At later stages of death phase, such bloom ensues to deficient nutrition and extensive multiplication of their predators. Alternatively, the absorbed nutrients, organic substances and photosynthates are released which support secondary bloom formation of various species of algae. During the process the bloom forming organisms ensure their supply of oxygen, photosynthesis, adopt buoyancy and form characteristic scums. Algal bloom / growth in water often turns harmful, e.g., certain toxic heavy metals are absorbed or adsorbed on algal cells or consumed. Once such accumulation reaches to sufficient level in algal cells, it may exhibit toxicity to the consumers like predators, fishes, birds or other aquatic organisms. Cyanobacterial blooms are harmful in many ways. One of these is secretion of toxic compounds which are active against cattles, fishes, fowl and even human beings (Schiwmmer and Schiwmmer, 1964, 1968). Other effects include: (a) Unpleasant taste to drinking water, (b) Mortality of fish, (c) Products of their decay release substances deleterious to aquatic animals, and (d) Release of certain endotoxins (Carmichael et al. 2001). One of such example was in 1995, when Anabaena circinalis caused odiferous water in Armidale (Australia) due to production of ‘Geosmin’ when living matter including algal sludge decomposed on a massive scale. Few bloomforming algae are: Aphanocapsa fusae, Microcystis aeruginosa, Microcystis flos-aquae, 166 167 Gloeotrichia, Oscillatoria, Anabaena, Aphanizomenon flos-aquae, Anabaenopsis flosaquae, dinoflagellate Gymnodinium, Prymnesium parvum etc. Excessive growth of algae destroys the recreational and aesthetic value of lakes. A thick mat of green algae Hydrodictyon could be observed in Yamuna river near water intake wells at Delhi. This algal mat resulted in considerable depletion of dissolved oxygen level. The example of the same is Dal Lake, which has come under stress due to anthropogenic influences. In the summer of 1991, placid and limpid waters of two basins of Dal Lake, viz., Gagribal and Boddal turned red which spread further and engulfed more adjacent lake areas. The causative organism and responsible factors for initiation and development of such a phenomenon in the lake became highly controversial and various theories were put forth. Investigations have shown that the organism Euglena rubra was responsible for imparting reddish colour to the waters. Similar types of euglenoid blooms, recorded in other places (Zafar 1986, Venkateshwarlu et al. 1981), were correlated with influx of higher levels of pollutants to the water body especially due to domestic sewage. The importance of iron in the distribution of Euglenoid flagellates has been pointed out by Khan (1993). Primary production data of phytoplankton are available for a number of water bodies ranging from small fish ponds to large lakes and rivers. The gross primary production (GPP) ranges from 37 mgCm-2 day-1 in Ramgarh lake (Gorakhpur) to above 17.5 gCm-2 day-1 in a sewage pond near Ahmedabad. In general, shallow lakes, fish ponds and temple tanks are more productive than deep lakes and reservoirs. Aquatic macrophytes Aquatic macrophytes can be efficient indicators of water quality, and their presence may enhance water quality due to their ability to absorb excessive loads of nutrients. These properties have been used in wastewater treatment as well as in biomanipulation of water bodies for enhancing fish production. In deep lakes and reservoirs, the macrophytes are mostly submerged and are confined to margins. Pandya and Kane (1976) observed maximum biomass of 126 g m-2 for submerged macrophytes in Lalpari lake, Rajkot. Kane (1977) reported net annual production by submerged macrophytes of 970 g m-2 in the Manasbal lake, Srinagar. The wetlands and epilittoral zones of large lakes dominated by large emergent vegetation like species of Typha, Phragmites etc. show very high values of standing crops and annual production. Kane (1977) recorded net annual production (above ground) from 1010 to 3000 gm-2 in different parts of Dal lake, Srinagar. Of this, the submerged macrophytes contributed only 292-351 g m-2. Gopal and Sharma (1978) found that standing crop in several wetlands in 167 168 different parts of Rajasthan ranged from 3300 gm-2 (Typha angustata) to 9730 gm-2 (Phagmites karka). Daily rate of production was estimated up to 30 g m-2 day-1. Rao and Gupta (1980) found that in Andhra Pradesh the major floating aquatic weeds were Eichhornia, Ipomoea, Pistia, Nelumbo, Nyphaea, Monochoria and Otella, while Hydrilla, Vallisnaria, Ulothrix, Spirogyra and Chara were observed to be the submerged weeds. Factors affecting algal bloom The factors required for algal growth include: Primary nutrients (C,N,P) as well as hydrogen and oxygen Minor and micronutrients Sufficient light energy in the water column Suitable water temperatures for growth Algae will continue to grow as long as all the above requirements are met. The rate of production depends highly on the quantity and quality/ suitability of the factors listed above. When one or more of the stated requirements are not available for growth, then algal productivity is said to be limited by that condition. Limitation of algal growth is best described by Liebig’s Law of the Minimum, which says that algal productivity will be limited by the element present in least supply relative to algal requirements (O’Brien 1974; Goldman and Horne 1983). Changes in temperature and light are the two main causes for algal production to vary significantly between seasons. In order to understand trophic status of the water body, preliminary screening can be made on the levels of parameters like Secchi disc transparency, chlorophyll-a and phosphorus (Table 2). However, nitrogen (Table 3) is also considered while classifying water bodies as per OECD (Rast et al.1989) 168 169 Table 2: Trophic State of Surface Waters Status Secchi Disc Depth (m) Chlorophyll -a (g/L) Total Phosphorus (g/L) Oligotrophic >5 <2 < 10 Mesotrophic 1.6 to 5 2 to 10 10 to 30 Eutrophic 0.7 to 1.6 10 to 30 30 to 60 Hypereutrophic < 0.7 > 30 > 60 Table 3: OECD boundary values for open trophic classification system Parameter Oligotrophic Mesotrophic Eutrophic Hypertrophic (annual mean values) Total X 8.0 26.7 84.4 phosphorous x±I SD 4.9-13.3 14.5-49 48-189 (µg P/l) x±2 2.9-22.1 7.9-90.8 16.8-424 SD range 3.0-17.7 10.9-95.6 16.2-386 750-1200 n 21 19 (21) 71(72) 2 Total X nitrogen (µg x±I SD N/l) x±2 SD range n 661 371-1180 208-2103 753 485-1170 313-1816 1875 861-4081 395-8913 307-1630 11 361-1387 8 393-6100 37 (38) Chlorophyll a (µg /l) 1.7 0.8-3.4 0.4-7.1 4.7 3.0-7.4 1.9-11.6 14.3 6.7-31 3.1-66 0.3-4.5 22 3.0-11 16 (17) 2.7-78 70 (22) X x±I SD x±2 SD range n 169 100-150 2 170 Chlorophyll X a peak value x±I SD (µg /l) x±2 SD range n 4.2 2.6-7.6 1.5-13 16.1 8.9-29 4.9-52.5 42.6 16.9-107 6.7-270 1.3-10.6 16 4.9-49.5 12 9.5-275 46 Secchi depth X (m) x±I SD x±2 SD Range N 9.9 5.9-16.5 3.6-27.5 4.2 2.4-7.4 1.4-13 2.45 1.5-4.0 0.9-6.7 5.4-28.3 13 1.5-8.1 20 0.8-7.0 70(72) 0.4-0.5 l. The geometric means (after being transformed to base 10 logarithms) were calculated after removing values which were greater than, or less than, two times the standard deviation obtained (where applicable) in the first calculation. x= geometric mean. SD= standard deviation. ( ) = the value in brackets refers to the number of variables (n) used in the first calculation. [Source: Modified from Organization for Economic Cooperation and Development 1982] Nutrients The relationship between various nitrogenous components and their use by the total algal biomass has been the subject in scientific studies. The different forms of nitrogen can be separated into organic and inorganic, as well as particulate and dissolved components. Particulate organic nitrogen is found in living biomass and detritus, while soluble organic nitrogenous materials are released into the water from excretion, secretion, and decomposition processes (Keeney 1973). Soluble inorganic nitrogen is represented primarily by four different molecules: nitrate (NO3-), nitrite (NO2), ammonia (NH3 / NH4+), and nitrogen gas (N2). Ammonia is the preferred form for plant growth because the incorporation of nitrate requires additional metabolic energy and enzymatic activity (Goldman and Horne 1983). Both algae and bacteria incorporate ammonia very rapidly (Sugiyama and Kawai 1979). The incorporation of nitrogen gas into algal biomass occurs through a process known as nitrogen fixation. 170 171 Transformations between different forms of nitrogen in water are influenced by environmental conditions (Keeney 1973) of the aquatic body. For example, ammonia is the principal nitrogenous by-product or organic decomposition and experiences different fates depending on where in the pond the ammonia is produced. In waters containing dissolved oxygen, ammonia not incorporated by algae, can be oxidised (i.e. add oxygen) through microbial processes. The oxidation of ammonia first to nitrite and then to nitrate is called nitrification (NH4+, NO2–, NO3-). In this two-step process, the microbial transformation of ammonia to nitrite is much slower than the subsequent microbial transformation of nitrite to nitrate (Cavari 1977, Goldman and Horne 1983). This has two implications; first, algal uptake of ammonia can be relatively fast, and competition for ammonia between algae and bacteria is predominantly in favour of the algal community; second, the relatively rapid oxidation of nitrite to nitrate that very little accumulates in toxic waters. Unlike N, phosphorus exists in relatively few dissolved and particulate forms in natural waters. No gaseous forms of P are common, although under anaerobic conditions, trace amounts of the unstable gas phosphine (PH3) may be generated. Overall, the main concern is with dissolved vs. particulate forms of inorganic and organic P. Dissolved inorganic P (DIP) exists as orthophosphate (PO43-), which is readily assimilated by all CHAB taxa. Many CHABs can accumulate assimilated P intracellularly as polyphosphates (Boström 1988). Polyphosphates can serve as internal stores of P for subsequent use in the event of ambient P depletion (Healy 1982). Dissolved organic P (DOP) can be a significant fraction of the total dissolved P pool. Based upon the relationship between epilimnetic P concentration and algal bloom frequency observed in various lakes, a linkage of empirical models relating summer mean P to summer mean chlorophyll-a (Carlson, 1977) and summer mean chlorophyll-a to algal bloom frequency (Walker, 1984; Heiskary and Walker, 1988) was established, and accordingly a P criterion of 0.02 mg l-1 (20 ppb) was selected (Fig.2). 171 172 Fig.2: Relationship of algal bloom and lake P Freshwater systems having low molar ratios of both total and soluble (biologically–available) N to P (<15) are most likely to experience cyanobacterial dominance (Smith 1983 1990). Conversely, waters having molar N: P ratios in excess of 20 are more likely to be dominated by eukaryotic algal taxa (Smith 1983). This rule has proven broadly applicable to periodically stratified, long residence (> 30 days) temperate and tropical freshwater systems (Downing et al. 2001). Excessive P (as orthophosphate) loading has been shown to promote potentially toxic nitrogen (N2) fixing genera (i.e., Anabaena, Aphanizomenon, Cylindrospermopsis, Nodularia), while excessive P and N (as dissolved inorganic N; nitrate and ammonium) loading can stimulate toxic blooms of non-N2 fixing genera (Microcystis, Lyngbya, Planktothrix). From a supply standpoint, both the absolute amounts and relative proportions of these nutrients play important roles in determining the composition, magnitude, and duration of CHABs (Cyanobacterial Harmful Algal Blooms). P enrichment (i.e., declining N: P ratios) frequently selects for the establishment of N2 fixing species (Paerl 1988). Once N2 fixers are established, non– diazotrophic species can remain a significant fraction of the phytoplankton, because they are able to utilize fixed N produced and released by N 2 fixing species (Paerl 1990). Co–existing diazotrophic and N–requiring bloom species are capable of buoyancy regulation, and thus a near–surface existence, in highly productive, turbid waters. Typically, Anabaena, Aphanizomenon and Microcystis, (the notorious trio, “Annie, Fannie and Mike”) co–occur under these circumstances. In clearer waters where light reaches the bottom, benthic N2 fixing and non–fixing assemblages (e.g., Lyngbya, some Oscillatoria, Microcoleus, 172 173 Scytonema, Phormidium) can predominate. Mixed assemblages often persist as a bloom “consortium” during summer and fall (Paerl 1983, 1986, 1987), until unfavourable physical conditions, such as cooling (<15oC) and water column turnover take place. There are exceptions to the N: P rule. These include; 1) systems in which both N and P loadings are very large (i.e., hypereutrophic systems in which N and P inputs exceed the assimilative capacity of the phytoplankton), and 2) highly– flushed, short residence time systems, in which the flushing rate exceeds growth or doubling rates of cyanobacteria (generally >1 d-1). In N and P enriched systems, N: P ratios may readily exceed 20, but since both N and P are being supplied at close to non–limiting rates, factors other than nutrient limitation (e.g., light, vertical mixing, residence time, salinity, organic matter content) may control algal community activity, biomass and composition. Under these conditions, N2 fixation confers little if any advantage, and non–N2 fixing taxa predominate. Often, these conditions favor high rates of primary production and biomass accumulation. Minerals and physical factors Besides nutrients like CNP, there is increasing interest in the role of trace metals in some systems. The most notable of these trace metals is iron (Fe) in its soluble form Fe++. Iron is required for the synthesis and activity of photosynthetic, N2 fixing and N assimilatory enzymes. Unlike N and P, Fe inputs are not strongly linked to human activities, such as agriculture, urbanization and most industrial activities. Rather, Fe availability is more often controlled by natural weathering or rocks, aeolian processes (dust transported by wind), and within-system oxygen (e.g., hypoxia) and biogeochemical (redox) cycling. There is also evidence that the production of toxic substances by CHABs is at least in part determined by the amounts and ratios of nutrients and trace metals supplied to affected water bodies (Sivonen 1996, Skulberg et al. 1994). Nutrient supply rates strongly interact with other environmental factors, including light, turbulence and flushing rates, temperature, pH (and inorganic C availability), salinity, and grazing pressure to determine; 1) if a specific water body is susceptible to CHAB formation, 2) the extent (magnitude, duration) to which CHABs may dominate planktonic and/ or benthic habitats, and, 3) whether an affected water body is amenable to management steps aimed at minimizing or eliminating CHABs. If the sewage discharge exceeds the self-purifying capacity of the aquatic environment, major alterations in the concentrations of dissolved oxygen (DO), hydrogen ion (pH), carbon dioxide (CO2), ammonical nitrogen (NH3-N), hydrogen sulphide (H2S), chlorine (Cl), nitrite (NO2) and nitrates (NO3) are bound to occur. The changes in these physico-chemical conditions of the 173 174 receiving water body would affect its normal ecology and biology in the following way. Alkaline water (pH 9.5 to 9.6) associated with supersaturation of dissolved oxygen (138-141 percent) concentration was found to be the cause of fish kill in shallow lake. Discharge of domestic sewage or treated effluents tend to increase the ammonical nitrogen concentrations in the natural water bodies. A limit of 5 mg/l of ammonical nitrogen has been suggested as the upper limit for the effluent quality before discharge into the streams and rivers during summer. A threshold concentration of 0.25 mg/l of unionized ammonia has been suggested for the freshwater fish. The amount of ammonia toleration varies from one species to the other. A great deal of variation (0.25 to 3.8 mg/l) in the lethal concentration of ammonia exists to different fish species. Presence of hydrogen sulphide in water bodies is due to the microbial decomposition of sewage, sludge, and animal and plant proteins. Different species of hydrogen sulphide toxicity to the fish have been reviewed earlier and it was noticed that under average water conditions, a concentration of 0.5 to 1.0 mg/l was critical for many sensitive fishes. Remedial measures One must first determine the nature of the eutrophication problem and decide on the goals of a control programme. The eutrophication problem in a given situation may be excessive growths of algae and/or macrophytes, decreased water transparency, hypolimnetic oxygen depletion and related fish kills, nutrient regeneration or water quality deterioration due to the regeneration of reduced chemicals, taste and odour problems in drinking water supply reservoirs, or a combination of these types of problems. In this manner, one can relate the major water use (or uses) of the lake or reservoir to the necessary water quality for such a use. Intended lake and reservoir water uses as related to trophic conditions (Bernhardt 1981) are presented in Table 4. Obviously, if the existing trophic state of a water body is compatible with the water use, no action is necessary in regard to phosphorus loading conditions. If not, both point and non-point phosphorus control measures may be necessary. 174 175 Table 4. Intended lake and reservoir water uses as related to trophic conditions Desired utilization Drinking water production Bathing purposes Low-water improvement with long distance supply line without long distance supply line Fish culture salmonid waterbodies cyprinid waterbodies Providing process water Cooling water production Water sports (without bathing) Landscaping in recreation areas Irrigation (by means of channels) Energy production 1. 2. 3. Trophic state Required oligotrophic mesotrophic Still tolerable Mesotrophic slightly eutrophic - Mesotrophic - slightly eutrophic oligotrophic mesotrophic mesotrophic Mesotrophic Eutrophic slightly eutrophic Eutrophic Eutrophic - slightly eutrophic1 - strongly eutrophic - strongly eutrophic2,3 Within the scope of landscaping, a eutrophic state caused by the natural ageing process, can even be desirable. Without consideration of the eventual water quality requirements for the receiving canal. Not valid for river power plants, which may be impaired by macrophyte and algal growths. [Source: Adapted from Bemhardt 1981] Options of restoration techniques First of all, there is a need to specify the purpose of restoration. Accordingly various options are available in the literature (Rast et al. 1981) as guidelines. The most important methods, applicable for specific sites worldwide, are listed below, and a brief description of their application, advantages, and disadvantages is given for each approach. It may be mentioned that some are more ecological and sustainable than others. 175 176 Diversion of wastewater Wastewater diversion has been used extensively to rehabilitate lakes, often replacing wastewater treatment. Discharge of effluents into an ecosystem that is less susceptible than the one used at present is, as such, a sound principle, which under all circumstances should be considered. Diversion might reduce the number of steps in the treatment but cannot replace wastewater treatment totally, as discharge of effluents should always require at least mechanical treatment to eliminate suspended matter. Diversion has often been used with a positive effect when eutrophication of a lake has been the dominant problem. Canalization, either to the sea or to the lake outlet, has been used as a solution in many cases of eutrophication. If canalization is a significant part of the overall cost of handling wastewater, it might often turn out to be both a better and cheaper solution to have smaller treatment units with individual discharge points. Although diversion is not considered an ecotechnological method based on sound ecological principles, a number of successful applications of diversion has been reported in the limnological literature. The most frequently cited case of wastewater diversion is probably the restoration of Lake Washington in Seattle, Washington. Wastewater was diverted from the lake to coastal Puget Sound in the 1960s, resulting in immediate improvement in Lake Washington. If diversion is accompanied by adding low-nutrient water from other sources, the recovery of the lake will, of course, take place faster. Removal of superficial sediment Sediment removal can be used to support the recovery process of very eutrophic lakes and of areas contaminated by toxic substances. This method can be applied in small ecosystems only with great care. Sediments have a high concentration of nutrients and many toxic substances, including trace metals. If a wastewater treatment scheme is initiated, the storage of nutrients and toxic substances in the sediment might prevent recovery of the ecosystem due to exchange processes between sediment and water. Anaerobic conditions might even accelerate these exchange processes; this is often observed for phosphorus, as iron(III) phosphate reacts with sulfide and forms iron(II) sulfide by release of phosphate. The amount of pollutants stored in the sediment is often significant, as it reflects the discharge of untreated wastewater for the period prior to the introduction of a treatment scheme. Thus, even though the retention time of the water is moderate, it might still take a very long time for the ecosystem to recover. Perhaps the best known case of removal of superficial sediment occurred in Lake Trummen in Sweden, where 40 cm of the superficial sediment was removed. The 176 177 transparency of the lake improved considerably, but it decreased again due to the phosphorus in overflows from rainwater basins. Treatment of the overflow after the removal of superficial sediment might give a better result. Uprooting and removal of macrophytes Uprooting and removal of macrophytes has been widely used in streams and to a certain extent in reservoirs. The method can, in principle, be used wherever macrophytes are a significant result of eutrophication. A mass balance should always be set up to evaluate the significance of the method compared with the total nutrient input. Collection of the plant fragments should be considered under all circumstances. Simultaneous removal of nutrients from the effluent should also be considered. Coverage of sediment by an inert material Covering sediment with inert material is an alternative to removal of superficial sediment. The idea is to prevent the exchange of nutrients (or perhaps, toxic substances) between sediment and water. Polyethylene, polypropylene, fiberglass screen, or clay is used to cover the sediment surface. The general applicability of the method is limited due to the high cost, even though it might be more moderate in cost than removal of superficial sediment. It has been used in only a few cases, and a more general evaluation of the method is still lacking. Siphoning hypolimnetic water from reservoirs In reservoirs or large ponds, this approach is feasible for reducing the causes of epilimnetic eutrophication and can be used over a longer period and thereby gives a pronounced overall effect. The effect depends on a significant difference between the nutrient concentrations in the epilimnion and the hypolimnion, which is often the case if the lake or reservoir has a pronounced thermocline. As hypolimnetic water is colder and poorer in oxygen, the thermocline will move downward and the possibility of anaerobic zones will be reduced. This might have an indirect effect on the release of nutrients from the sediment. If there are lakes or reservoirs downstream, the method cannot be used, as it removes but does not solve the problem. A possibility in such cases would be to remove phosphorus from the hypolimnetic water before it is discharged downstream. The low concentration of phosphorus in hypolimnetic water (perhaps 0.5 to 1.0 mg L-1) compared with wastewater makes it almost impossible to apply chemical precipitation. Several lakes have been restored by this method, mainly in Austria, Slovenia, and Switzerland, with a significant decrease in the phosphorus concentration as 177 178 a result. Generally, the decline in total phosphorus concentration in the epilimnion is proportional to the amount of total phosphorus removed by siphoning and to the time the process has been used. Flocculation of phosphorus Either aluminum sulfate or iron (III) chloride can be added to lakes or reservoirs to stimulate the flocculation and subsequent settling of phosphorus from surface waters. Calcium hydroxide cannot be used, even though it is an excellent precipitant for wastewater, as its effect is pH-dependent and a pH of 9.5 or higher is required. The method is not generally recommended, as (1) it is not certain that all flocs will settle and thereby incorporate the phosphorus in the sediment, and (2) the phosphorus might again be released from the sediment at a later stage. Water circulation and aeration Circulation of water can be used to break down the thermocline. This might prevent the formation of anaerobic zones, and thereby the release of phosphorus from sediment. Aeration of lakes and reservoirs is a more direct way to prevent anaerobic conditions from occurring. Aeration of highly polluted rivers and streams has also been used to avoid anaerobic conditions. In the Danish Lake Hald, pure oxygen has been used instead of air. The water quality of the lake has been improved permanently since the oxygenation started. In most cases, however, the effect was not very great nor as permanent as with other techniques, such as siphoning of hypolimnetic water. Hydrologic regulation Regulation of hydrology has been used extensively to prevent floods. More recently, it has also been considered as a workable method to change the ecology of lakes, reservoirs, and wetlands. If the retention time in a lake or a reservoir is reduced with the same annual input of nutrients, eutrophication will decrease due to decreased nutrient concentrations. The role of the depth, which can be regulated by use of a dam, is more complex. Increased depth has a positive effect on the reduction of eutrophication, but if the retention time is increased simultaneously, the overall effect cannot generally be quantified without the use of a model. The productivity of wetlands is highly dependent on the water level, which makes it highly feasible to control a wetland ecosystem by this method. 178 179 Fertilizer control Controlling high nutrient water from even getting into a lake or reservoir is, of course, the best action to prevent signs of eutrophication. Fertilizer control can be used in agriculture and forestry to reduce nutrient loss to the environment. Utilization of nutrients by plants depends on a number of factors [temperature, humidity of soil, composition, growth rate of plant (which again depends on a number of factors), chemical speciation of nutrients, etc.]. The occurrence of cyanophyte blooms to a great extent determines the N: P ratio in the lake water. If the ratio is less than 5, at least 50 percent of the blooms are in the form of cyanophytes. By very low ratios (e.g., less than 2), an almost 100 percent cyanophyte bloom may be observed. Adjusting the ratio is possible to a certain extent, as the main source of phosphorus is primarily wastewater. The phosphorus concentration in treated wastewater can easily be reduced by chemical precipitation to 1 mg L-1 and even to 0.1 mg L-1. To avoid cyanophyte blooms, it is important to utilize all the possibilities, for example, fertilizer control, wastewater treatment, and various restoration methods to obtain the right N: P ratio, which means > 7. Calcium hydroxide neutralization Calcium hydroxide is used widely to neutralize low pH values in streams and lakes in areas where acidic rain has a significant impact. Sweden spends about $100 million per year to neutralize acid in streams and lakes. Algaecides Chemicals, such as, various copper salts (e.g., copper sulfate) were previously used widely in relatively small lakes, but are now rarely used due to the general toxicity of copper, which accumulates in the sediment and can thereby contaminate a lake for a very long time. The effect of copper on algae varies substantially from species to species. Blue-green algae are generally most sensitive to copper ions. Mitsch and Kaltenborn (1980) performed in situ measurements of metabolism in the euphotic zone of an Illinois lake. Although few differences were seen in a treated lake compared to a control lake, during one period about a week after CuSO4 treatments, gross primary productivity appeared to be depressed. However, by 10 to 14 days after the treatment, the effects of the treatment on metabolism had disappeared. Obviously copper gets accumulated in living organisms and there is strong possibility of biomagnifications in animals at higher trophic levels. 179 180 Shoreline vegetation Shading by use of trees at the shoreline is a cost-effective method that can give an acceptable result for small lakes, due to their low area/circumference ratio. It is relatively ineffective in restoring large lakes because of the smaller edge/area ratio. Biomanipulation Biomanipulation can be used as a method of lake restoration if the phosphorus concentration ranges from about 50 to 150 g L-1, depending on the lake. In this range two ecological structures are possible. When the phosphorus concentration initially is low and increases, zooplankton are able to maintain a relatively low phytoplankton concentration by grazing. carnivorous fish are also able to maintain a low concentration of planktivorous fish, which implies relatively low predation on zooplankton. At a certain phosphorus concentration (about 120 to 150 g L-1), zooplankton is no longer able to control the phytoplankton concentration by grazing, and as carnivorous fish hunt by sight and the turbidity increases, planktivorous fish become more abundant, which involves more pronounced predation on zooplankton). There are two possible ecological structures in the phosphorus range of approximately 50 to 150 g L-1. Biomanipulation (Giussani and Galanti 1995) can be used in this range to make a "shortcut" by removal of planktivorous fish and release of carnivorous fish. If biomanipulation is used at above 150 g-P L-1, some intermediate improvement of the water quality would be necessary, but the lake will sooner or later get an ecological structure corresponding to the high phosphorus concentration (i.e., a structure controlled by phytoplankton and planktivorous fish). Biomanipulation is a relatively cheap and effective method provided that it is applied in the phosphorus range where two ecological structures are possible. There are a number of cases where biomanipulation has been successful, but only if the phosphorus loading was reduced simultaneously with total phosphorus concentrations were made below 150 g L-1. Benndorf (1990) mentioned that consistent response to biomanipulation can only be foreseen with a loading of less than about 0.6 to 0.8 g P m-2 yr-1. The Chinese grass carp or white amur (Ctenopharyngodon idella val) feeds primarily on submerged plants. It also feeds on small floating plants. It thrives best under cool waters although it tolerates warm waters. The small fish consume vegetation several times of their body weight. For every one gram increase in fish weight it needs to consume 48 g Hydrilla. About 75 fish can 180 181 consume a vegetation of one hectare. White amur is now increasingly used for clearing aquatic vegetation in India. Among the indigenous species of fish Puntius pulchellus showed great promise (Devraj and Manissery 1979). It was estimated that 10,000 fingerlings of this fish (each weighing 10 to 14 g) consume Lemma and Hydrilla weighing 25 to 50 kg/day and 9 to 18 tons of aquatic weeds per year. The other fish species found useful for aquatic weed control are Tilapia (T. zilli and T. quineensis), silver carp (Hypopthalmichthys molitrix), silver dollarfish (Metynnis roosvelti val.), common carp (Cyprinus carpio L), gold fish (Carassius auratus), etc. Among the various diseases of water hyacinth, thread blight caused by Marasmiellus inoderma (Berk), Singh, and a disease caused by Alternaria eichhorniae are among the potential biological agents for controlling the growth of this weed. The fungi which showed promise against water hyacinth are Cercospora rodmanii, Acromonium zonatum and Ureds eichhornia. The insects found effective are flea beetle (Agasiches hydrophilla) on water hyacinth and Salvinia, and thrips (Amgnotthrips andersoni) and moth (Vogtia mallloi) on the weeds. In South America, a grasshopper, Paulinia acuminate De Geer attacks Salvinia spp. and Azolla spp.) In India, an aquatic snail Limnaea acuminata has been observed to be a good biological agent for control of Salvinia (Ittyavarah et al. 1979). Location of treatment Attempt should be made to estimate the nutrient load that the wetland can sustain and accordingly identify the treatment options for implementation at desired locations. Desired nutrient load Determination of the ‘acceptable’ nutrient load to a lake or reservoir is increasingly being accomplished through the determination of total maximum daily loads, using a process known as waste-load allocation. In this process, all the possible nutrient sources (point and non-point) in a drainage basin are identified and quantified. This is either by direct measurement or by prescribed estimation techniques. One example of the latter is regionally relevant unit area loads (sometimes termed nutrient export coefficients; see Rast and Lee 1983). This information is then compared with the maximum permissible nutrient load that will still allow achievement of the ‘desired’ trophic state in a downstream 181 182 lake or reservoir. The term ‘desired’ is based on the trophic condition which allows a specific human-designed water use(s) to be achieved. If the estimated nutrient load exceeds the level conducive to a desired water use(s), the required reduction in the nutrient load to achieve the desired tropic state can be calculated. Point sources Oligotrophic waters often have an N/P ratio greater than or equal to 10, which means that phosphorus is less abundant than nitrogen relative to the needs of phytoplankton. If sewage is discharged into the lake, the ratio will decrease, since the N: P ratio for municipal wastewater is about 3:1, and consequently, nitrogen will be less abundant than phosphorus relative to the needs of phytoplankton. Municipal wastewater typically contains 30 mg-N L-1 and 10 mgP L-1. In this situation, however, the best remedy for excessive algal growth is not necessarily the removal of nitrogen from the sewage, because the mass balance might show that nitrogen-fixing algae would produce an uncontrollable input of nitrogen into the lake. Efficient eutrophication control methods can be managed by eliminating the root-cause / the after effects and the nutrients from polluting sources (drainage etc.) to check plant and phytoplankton growth into the water bodies (Lee et al. 1980, Bern Hardt 1981, Rast and Holland 1988, Ryding and Rast 1989). Eutrophication control measures, at least in developed countries, have focused primarily on the reduction of the external phosphate load to water bodies. As noted by Ryding and Rast (1989), this is generally thought to be the most effective, long-term measure for attempting to control cultural eutrophication. This is typically achieved by removing phosphate from wastewaters at municipal wastewater treatment plants, via its precipitation from the wastewater before its release in effluents (usually termed tertiary treatment). In extreme cases, phosphorus removal can also be applied directly to a lake or reservoir by applying aluminium or iron salts, or in some instances calcium salts, directly to the water column (although trivalent cations are generally more effective in removing phosphorus from the water column). Numerous case studies from throughout the world illustrating phosphorus removal from wastewater effluents and/or water bodies are given in Dunst et al. (1974) and Ryding and Rast (1989). Non-point sources The control of nutrients from non-point sources in a drainage basin has lagged behind the control of nutrients from point sources, both in terms of available technologies and the legal requirements for implementation. Available technologies for achieving control of urban non-point source nutrients, metals and sediments have been reviewed by Stahre and Urbonas (1990). These 182 183 technologies consist primarily of detention, retention and infiltration techniques. They are based on a system of containment and release that parallels traditional wastewater or flood control engineering. It relies primarily on the stilling of storm waters to allow sedimentation of particulates and adsorbed contaminants. The subsequently produced supernatant can then either be discharged downstream with reduced sediment and contaminant load, transferred to a wastewater treatment facility for final ‘polishing’, or allowed to percolate into the substratum. In-lake control In-lake control of eutrophication, via the application of alum or other multivalent cation salts directly to a water body, has been undertaken much less frequently than the control of point sources. Such applications are costly, logistically difficult and usually only partially effective, compared with reducing the external nutrient load to a water-body. Examples of the application of this method are given in Dunst et al. (1974). In fact, this control method is usually attempted only when point and/or non-point source control measures applied in a drainage basin have failed to achieve the desired reduction in trophic state, or in situations in which the nutrient content in the bottom sediments of a lake or reservoir has accumulated to the extent that internal loading from the sediments is anticipated. In some water bodies, in fact, the internally generated phosphorus load can equal or even exceed the external nutrient load (Ryding 1981, 1985). Such extraordinary internal nutrient loads usually can be moderated by alum treatments. However, the removal of the contaminated sediments, via dredging, is the more common alternative. This is especially the case for shallow lakes, in which alum addition to the water column cannot generally establish a cohesive flocculent ‘blanket’ at the sediment-water interface to induce nutrient sedimentation, due to wind-induced turbulent mixing (Ryding 1982). Rast et al. (1989) has documented certain guidelines towards in-lake control measures (Table 5) of eutrophication. Decomposing barley straw has successfully been used to control the growth of cyanobacteria (Microcystis, Anabaena and Aphanizomenon ) under field condition. The straw was effective for controlling overall growth of cyanobacteria compared to controls (Rajabi et al. 2010). 183 184 Table 5: Water quality problems treatable by in-lake restoration measures Odours Control meseare Dredging Hypolimnetic aeration Nutrient inactivation Altered circulation Algicides Biomanipulation Dilution/flushing Removal of hypolimnetic waters Lake drawdown Harvesting Covering sediments X Fish kills Trophic algae X X Water quality problem Interference Reduced Excessive with commercial macrophyte swimming fishing growth X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X Excessive algal blooms X X X X Poor drinking water quality X X X X Select success stories Numerous examples of the assessment and control of eutrophication exist, although most are overwhelmingly from lakes situated in the northern hemisphere (Chapman 1992). Perhaps most well-known (and well-documented) is the case of Lake Washington (USA). This lake rapidly eutrophied in the postSecond World War years as a result of the discharge of wastewater from several neighbouring municipalities (Edmondson et al. 1956). Subsequent installation of wastewater treatment plants and the diversion of wastewaters away from the lake resulted in nearly complete recovery of the water body to its former (natural) state (Edmondson and Lehman 1981). In contrast, Lake Shagawa (USA) is probably the antithesis of successful eutrophication management. This lake also received municipal wastewater, which was subsequently treated to tertiary standards using a calcium carbonate flocculation technique (Larsen et al. 1979). Unlike Lake Washington, however, Shagawa Lake failed to respond as predicted and remained eutrophic. Further investigation determined that the lake was subject to extremely intense internal loading from anoxic hypolimnetic sediments. Owing to its shallow nature, much of the nutrient released from the sediments was mixed into the lake in sufficient amounts to continue to fuel nuisance levels of aquatic plant and algal growth (Larsen et al. 1981). Although 184 185 the reduction in the external load has resulted in some improvement in water quality, the complete recovery of this lake is expected to take close to a century as a result of continued leaching of phosphorus from the sediments (Chapra and Canale 1991). Blue-green algae dominated the open waters of Lake Victoria during an algal bloom between February and August 1986. Microcystis sp. accounted for more than 90% of the bloom organisms with algal counts reaching a high density of 34,000 colonies per ml. Secchi disc visibilities and the 1 % light penetration were reduced to 0–2 m and 1 m, respectively. The release of nutrients from river inflows, from upwelling and from sediments into the euphotic zone, coupled with high temperatures, produced the observed blooms. The blooms subsequently declined as a result of physical flushing, temperature reduction associated with the rainy season and nutrient exhaustion (Ochumba and Kibaara 1989). References Abeliovich, A. and Shilo, M. 1972. Photooxidative death in blue-green algae, J. Bacteriol., 111:682-689. Benndorf, J., 1990. Conditions for effective biomanipulation. Conclusions derived from whole-lake experiments in Europe. Hydrobiol., 200:201, 187–203. Bern Hardt, H. 1981. Reducing nutrient inflows. In: W. Rast & J.J. Kerekes (Compilers), Proceedings of International Workshop on the Control of Eutrophication.Laxenburg, 1215 October 1981, 43-51. Unesco, Paris and IIASA, Laxenburg. Bernhardt 1981[ Referred by Rast,W., M. Holland and S.O. Ryding 1989. Eutrophication management framework for the policy-maker by the United Nations Educational, Scientific and Cultural Organization; Paris] Boström B., Andersen, J. M., Fleischer, S. and Jansson, M. 1988. Exchange of phosphorus across the sediment-water interface. Hydrobiol., 170: 229–244. Campbell, N. A. 1987. Biology. Benjamin/Cummings Publishing Company Inc., Redwood City. Carlson, R.E. 1977. A Trophic State Index for Lakes. Limnol. Oceanogr.,22: 361369. Carmichael, W.W., Azevedo, M.F.O., An, J.S., Molica, R.J.R., Jochimsen, E.M., Lau, S., Rinehart, K.L., Shaw, G.R., Eagelsham, G.K. 2001. Human Fatalities from Cyanobacteria: 185 186 Chemical and Biological Evidence for Cyanotoxins. Environ. Health Perspectives, 109 (7):663-668. Chapman, D. 1992. Water Quality Assessments: a Guide to the Use of Biota, Sediments and Water in Environmental Monitoring; Chapman and Hall, London. 585 pp. Chapra, S. C. and Canale, R. P. 1991. Long-term phenomenological model of phosphorus and oxygen for stratified lakes, Wat. Res., 25: 707-715. Davelaar, D. 1993. Ecological significance of bacterial polyphosphate metabolism in sediments, Hydrobiol., 253: 179–192 Devraj, K.V.and Manissery, J.K. 1979. Preliminary studies on the utilization of indigenous carp Putius pulchellus as one of the biological agents of weed controls in ponds; Pro. Symp. Integrated weed control, Parbhani, Marathwada Agricultural Univ. pp 82-89. Downing, J.A., Watson S.B., McCauley, E. 2001. Predicting Cyanobacteria dominance in lakes. Can. J. Fish. Aquat. Sci., 58: 1905–1908. Dunst, R. C., Born, S. M., Uttormark, P. D., Smith, S. A., Nichols, S. A,, Peterson. J. 0.. Knauer, D. R., Serns, S. L., Winter, D. R., and Wirth. T. L. 1974. Survev of Lake Rehabilitation Techniques and Experiences. Wisconsin Department of Natural Resour. Tech.Bull. 15, 179 pp. Edmondson. W. T., Anderson, G. C., and Peterson, D. R. 1956. Artificial eutrophication of Lake Washington, Limnol. Oceanogr., 1: 47-53. Edmondson. W. T. and Lehman, J. R. 1981. The effect of changes in the nutrient income on the condition of Lake Washington, Limnol. Oceanogr., 26: 1-29. Einsele, W. 1936. Über die Beziehungen des Eisenkreislaufs zum Phosphatkreislauf im eutrophen See. Arch. Hydrobiol., 29: 664–686. Gächter, R. and Meyer, J. S. 1993. The role of microorganisms in mobilization and fixation of phosphorus in sediments. Hydrobiol., 253: 103–121. Gächter, R. and Müller, B. 2003. Why the phosphorus retention of lakes does not necessarily depend on the oxygen supply to their sediment surface. Limnol. Oceanogr., 48: 929–933. Giussani, G. and Galanti, G., 1995. Case Study: lake Candia (Northern Italy) 135-146. In: De Bernardi, R. and Giussani (ed). Guidelines of Lake Management, Volume 7, Biomanipulation in Lakes and Reservoirs, G. ILEC and UNEP. 211 pp. 186 187 Gopal, B. and Sharma, K.P. 1981. Water hyacinth (Eichhornia crassipes), the most troublesome weed of the world. Hindasia Publishers, New Delhi; 219 pp. Haglund, A. L., Lantz, P., Tornblom, E. and Tranvik, L. 2003. Depth distribution of active bacteria and bacterial activity in lake sediment. FEMS Microbiol. Ecol., 46: 31–38 Healy, F.P. 1982. Phosphate. In: Carr, N.G. and Whitton, B.A. (eds) The Biology of Cyanobacteria.Blackwell Scientific Public, Oxford, pp. 105–124. Heiskary, S.A. & Walker, W.W. 1988. Developing Phosphorus Criteria for Minnesota Lakes, Lake and Reservoir Management, 4: 1-10. Horan, N.J. 1990. Biological Waste Water Treatment Systems: Theory and Operation. JohnWiley and Sons, New York. Ingall, E. and Jahnke, R. 1997. Influence of water-column anoxia on the elemental fractionation of carbon and phosphorus during sediment diagenesis. – Mar. Geol., 139: 219–229. Ittyavarah et al. 1979 [Referred by Chaudhary, P. R., Pandey, R. A. and Bal, A. S. 1998. Macrophyte infestation of water bodies and methods of lake restoration, p 200-229. in Conservation and Management of Aquatic Resources; Daya Publishing House, Delhi]. Khan, M. A. 1993. Euglenoid Red-bloom Contributing to the Environmental Pollution of Dal Lake, Kashmir Himalaya. Environ. Conserv., 20 (4): 352-356. Larsen, D. P., Van Sickle, J., Malueg, K. W. and Smith, P. D. 1979. The effect of wastewater phosphorus removal on Shagawa Lake, Minnesota: phosphorus supplies, lake phosphorus and chlorophyll a, Wat. Res., 13, 1259- 1272. Larsen, D. P., Schultz, D. W., and Malueg, K. W. 1981. Summer internal phosphorus supplies in Shagawa Lake, Minnesota, Limnol. Oceanogr., 26, 740-753. Lee, G. F., Jones, R. A., and Rast, W. 1980. Availability of phosphorus to phytoplankton and its implications for phosphorus management strategies. In: Loehr, R.C., Martin, C. and Rast, W. (eds.), Phosphorus Management Strategies for Lakes. Interscience, Ann Arbor. pp. 259-308. Megan, K.O., Patricia, R., Paul, W., Roland, I. H. and Robert, E. H. 2011. Paleolimnological evidence of the effects of recent cultural eutrophication during the last 200 years in Lake Malawi, East Africa; J. Great Lakes Res., 37(1): 61-74. Mitsch, W.J., Kaltenborn, K, S. 1980. Effects of copper sulfate application on diel dissolved oxygen and metabolism in the Fox Chain of Lakes. Ill. State Acad. Sci. 73:55-64 187 188 Mortimer, C. H. 1941. The exchange of dissolved substances between mud and water in lakes. J. Ecol. 29: 280–329. Ochumba, P. B. O. and Kibaara, D. I. 1989. Observations on blue-green algal blooms in the open waters of Lake Victoria, Kenya. African J. of Ecol., 27: 23–34 Paerl, H.W. 1983. Environmental factors promoting and regulating N2 fixing blue–green algal blooms in the Chowan River, NC. Univ of North Carolina Water Resources Research Instit Report No. 176, 65 pp. Paerl, H.W. 1986. Growth and reproductive strategies of freshwater blue–green algae (cyanobacteria), In: Sandgren, C.D. (ed.) Growth and Reproductive Strategies of Freshwater Phytoplankton. Cambridge Univ Press. Paerl, H.W. 1987. Dynamics of blue–green algal blooms in the lower Neuse River, NC: Causative factors and potential controls. Univ of North Carolina Water Resources Research Institute Report No 229, 164 pp. Paerl, H.W. 1988. Nuisance phytoplankton blooms in coastal, estuarine and inland waters. Limnol Oceanogr. 33:823–847. Paerl, H.W. 1990. Physiological ecology and regulation of N2 fixation in natural waters. Adv. Microbiol. Ecol., 11:305–344. Rajabi, H., Y. Filizadeh, M. Soltani and Fotokian, M.H. 2010. The Use of Barley Straw for Controlling of Cyanobacteria Under Field Application. J. Fish. Aquatic Sci., 5: 394-401. Rast, W., Holland, M. and Ryding , S.O. 1989. Eutrophication management framework for the policy-maker by the United Nations Educational, Scientific and Cultural Organization; Paris. Rast, W. and Holland, M. M. 1988. ‘Eutrophication of lakes and reservoirs: a framework for making management decisions’, Ambio, 17: 2-12. Rast, W. and Lee, G. F. 1983. ‘Evaluation of nutrient loading estimates for lakes’, J. Environ. Engrg. Div.. ASCE, 109: 502-517. Reynolds, C.S., Walsby, A.E. 1975. Water blooms. Biol. Rev., 50:437-481. Roden, E. E. and Edmonds, J. W. 1997. Phosphate mobilization in iron-rich anaerobic sediments: Microbial Fe (III) oxide reduction versus iron-sulfide formation. Arch. Hydrobiol., 139: 347–378. Ryding, S.0. 1981. ‘Reversibility of man-induced eutrophication: experiences of a lake recovery in Sweden’, Int . Rev. ges. Hydrobiol., 66: 449-503. 188 189 Ryding, S.0. 1982. ‘Lake Trehorningen Restoration Project: changes in water quality after sediment dredging’, Hydrobiol., 92: 549-558. Ryding, S.0. 1985. ‘Chemical and microbiological processes as regulators of the exchange of substances between sediment and water in shallow, eutrophic lakes, Int. Rev. ges. Hydrobiol., 70: 657-702. Ryding, S.0. and Rast, W. 1989. The Control of Eutrophication of Lakes and Reservoirs. Man and the Biosphere Ser. I , Parthenon, Carnforth. 314 pp. Sannigrathi, P. and E. Ingall 2005. Polyphosphates as a source of enhanced P fluxes in marine sediments overlain by anoxic waters: Evidence from 31P NMR. – Geochem. Trans. 6: 52–59. Schwimmer, D., Schwimmer, M. 1964. Algae and Medicine. in Algae and Man. Jackson, D.F. (ed.) Plenum Press, New York, pp. 368-412. Schwimmer, D., Schwimmer, M. 1968. Medical Aspects of Phycology. in Algae, Man and the Environment. In: Jackson, D.F. (ed.) Syracuse University Press, Syracuse, N.Y. pp. 279-358. Sivonen, K. 1996. Cyanobacterial toxins and toxin production. Phycol., 35: 12-24. Skulberg, O.M., Carmichael, W.W., Codd, G.A., Skulberg, R. 1994. Taxonomy of toxic cyanophyceae (cyanobacteria). In: Falconer (ed.) Algal toxins in seafood and drinking water.Academic Press, New York, p 177–187. Smith, V.H. 1983. Low nitrogen to phosphorus ratios favor dominance by blue–green algae in lake phytoplankton. Science, 221:669–671. Smith, V.H. 1990. Nitrogen, phosphorus, and nitrogen fixation in lacustrine and estuarineecosystems. Limnol Oceanogr 35:1852–1859 Stahre, P. and Urbonas, B. 1990. Stormwater Detention for Drainage, Water Quality and CSO Management. Prentice Hall, Englewood Cliffs. 338 pp. Sugiyama, M. and Kawai, A., 1979. Microbiological studies on the nitrogen cycle in aquatic environments-VI. Metabolic rate of ammonium nitrogen in a goldfish culturing pond. Bull.Jpn. Soc. Sci. Fish., 45(6): 785-789. Uhlmann, D. 1984. Evaluation of strategies for controlling eutrophication of lakes and reservoirs. Internat. Revue der gesamten Hydrobiol. und Hydrogr. 67:821-835. Uhlmann, D., K. Röske, K. U. Ulrich and L. Paul, 1998. Bacteria in the bottom sediment of a drinking water reservoir. – Internat. Rev. Hydrobiol., 83: 269–280. 189 190 Venkateshwarlu et al. 1981 [Referred by Chaudhary, P. R., Pandey, R. A. and Bal, A. S. 1998. Macrophyte infestation of water bodies and methods of lake restoration, p 200-229, in Conservation and Management of Aquatic Resources; Daya Publishing House, Delhi]. Walker, W.W. 1984. "Statistical Bases for Mean Chlorophyll-a Criteria", in "Lake and Reservoir Management - Practical Applications", Proc. 4th Annual Conference, North American Lake Management Society, McAfee, New Jersey, 57-62. Walsby, A.E. 1987. Mechanisms of buoyancy regulation by planktonic cyanobacteria with gas vesicles. In: Fay, P. & van Baalen, C. (eds.) The cyanobacteria, Elsevier, Amsterdam, 377−390. Wetzel, R. G. 1999. Organic phosphorus mineralization in soils and sediments, pp. 225– 245. – In: Reddy, K. R., O’Connor, G. A. and Schelske, C. L. (eds.), Phosphorus Biogeochemistry in subtropical ecosystems. Lewis Publishers. Zafar 1986. [Referred by Chaudhary, P. R., Pandey, R. A. and Bal, A. S. 1998. Macrophyte infestation of water bodies and methods of lake restoration, p 200-229, in Conservation and Management of Aquatic Resources; Daya Publishing House, Delhi]. 190 191 Journal of Today’s Biological Sciences: Research & Review (JTBSRR) ISSN 2320-1444 (Online) JTBSRR Vol.1, Issue 1, page 191-196, December 30, 2012 Available on: www.jtbsrr.in Nanomedicine “A Future Medicine ” Gurudutt Joshi Surat medical Institute of medical education and Research (S.M.I.M.E.R.), Surat, Gujarat, E-mail: joshigurudutt@yahoo.com Abstract Nano, as in nanotechnology, nanobiology, nanomedicine, refers to phenomena at the nanometer or molecular level. A nanometer (nm) is one-billionth of 1 m, which is an extremely small linear measurement. To put this in perspective, a typical human hair is ≈100,000 nm in diameter. An adenovirus is 90-nm wide. Evolution of this technology has revolutionalized and opened many new gateways in medical research, therapeutic applications and newer perspectives. This article is a compilation of references and is written with a view to provide a basic idea and to expose scientific personnel to this promising and advance technology in combination with medicine. Key Words: Nanomedicine, medical research, nanosystem, nanodevices Introduction Nanomedicine has been defined as the monitoring, repair, construction and control of human biological systems at the molecular levels using engineered nanodevices and nanostructures [1]. It is the process of diagnosing, treating, and preventing disease and traumatic injury, of relieving pain, and of preserving and improving human health, using molecular tools and molecular knowledge of the human body [2]. Relevant processes of living organisms occur basically at 191 192 nanometer scale, elementary biological units like DNA, proteins or cell membranes are of this dimension. [3] In the relatively near term, nanomedicine can address many important medical problems by using nanoscale-structured materials and simple nanodevices that can be manufactured today, including the interaction of nanostructured materials with biological systems. Nanomedicine represents medicine at the nanotechnology scale with typical examples being nanoparticles and nanodevices. [4] Medical Nanomaterials and Nanodevices Nanopores One of the simplest medical nanomaterials is a surface perforated with holes, or Nanopores. It is one of the earliest therapeutically useful nanodevices employing bulk micromachining to fabricate tiny cell containing chambers filled with single silicon wafers.[5] These pores are large enough to allow small molecules such as oxygen, glucose, and insulin to pass, but are small enough to impede the passage of much larger immune system molecules such as immunoglobulins and graft-borne virus particles. Nanopore-based DNA sequencing devices could allow per-pore read rates potentially up to 1000 bases per second, possibly eventually providing a low-cost high-throughput method for very rapid genome sequencing.[6] Artificial Binding Sites and Molecular Imprinting Molecular imprinting is an existing technique in which a cocktail of functionalized monomers interacts reversibly with a target molecule using only noncovalent forces.[7] Molecularly imprinted polymers could be medically useful in clinical applications such as controlled drug release, drug monitoring devices, quick biochemical separations and assays, recognition elements in biosensors and chemosensors, and biological and receptor mimics including artificial antibodies. [8]. Quantum Dots and Nanocrystals These dots are tiny particles measuring only a few nanometers across, about the same size as a protein molecule or a short sequence of DNA. Quantum dots are useful for studying genes, proteins and drug targets in single cells, tissue specimens, and living animals.[9][10] Quantum Dots are being investigated as chemical sensors[11] for cancer cell detection ,gene expression studies[12] ,gene 192 193 mapping [13] ,immunocytochemical probes screening.[15] [14] ,medical diagnostics and drug Fullerenes and Nanotubes Soluble derivatives of fullerenes such as C60 have shown great utility as pharmaceutical agents. Fullerene compounds may serve as antiviral agents most notably against HIV photodynamic antitumor and anticancer therapies, antioxidants and anti-apoptosis agents which may include treatments for amyotrophic lateral sclerosis and Parkinson’s disease.[15] Nanoshells and Magnetic Nanoprobes They are developed as a platform for nanoscale drug delivery . They are slightly larger than Fullerenes.Nanoshells are embedded in a drug-containing tumor targeted hydrogel polymer and injected into the body.They circulate in the body ,when they reach target , the polymer gets melted by laser and drug is released at specific site , this technique can be useful in Diabetes to release Insulin and antibodies targeted against specific tumor cells. Dendrimers and Dendrimer-Based Devices Dendrimers are tree-shaped synthetic molecules with a regular branching structure emanating outward from a core that form nanometer by nanometer, with the number of synthetic steps. Upon encountering a living cell, dendrimers of a certain size by endocytosis release DNA which migrates to the nucleus where it becomes part of the cell’s genome. Radio-Controlled Biomolecules Tiny Radiofrequency antennas attached to nano sized gold nanocrystals ,by exposing them to radiofrequency magnetic field can be utilized ,to separate double stranded DNA and by remote electronic switching of these antennas to turn genes off and on. Researchers from the University of Missouri (MO, USA) have designed a new treatment for prostate tumors using radioactive gold nanoparticles (AuNPs) and epigallocatechin-gallate (EGCg),a compound found in tea leaves. The team, has synthesized biocompatible nanoparticles (NPs) utilizing the redox chemistry of EGCg, which converts gold salt into AuNPs.[19] 193 194 Nanorobots Nanoscale devices such as artificial R.B.C.or ‘Respirocyte” and artificial mechanical “W.B.C.” called “Microbivore”. Respirocyte can be used to carry more oxygen . Primary medical applications of respirocytes would include transfusable blood substitution; partial treatment for anemia, lung disorders, enhancement of cardiovascular/neurovascular procedures, tumour therapies and diagnostics, prevention of asphyxia, artificial breathing. Microbivore, has as its primary function to destroy microbiological pathogens found in the human bloodstream using a digest and discharge protocol. The Microbivore would be 80 times more efficient as phagocytic agents and would have far larger maximum lifetime capacity for phagocytosis than natural white blood cells.Microbivores would fully eliminate septicemic infections in minutes to hours.[18] Nanozymes The nanoparticle-based enzyme system . RNA silencing is an integral process in the normal functioning of cells, carried out in part by the RNA-induced silencing complex (RISC). This process can be synthetically exploited in the treatment of HCV infection, since if a key HCV RNA sequence can be targeted and destroyed.[17] Nanolipogels In a recent Nature Materials paper, a group of scientists from Yale University (CT, USA) has described the development of nanoscale liposomal polymeric gels termed ‘nanolipogels’, which have shown efficacy in mice models for the immunotherapeutic treatment of metastatic melanoma.[20] Many such novel nanoparticles and nanodevices are expected to be used, with an enormous positive impact on human health. The vision is to improve health by enhancing the efficacy and safety of nanosystems and nanodevices. References P. Webster 2005..World nanobiotechnology market .Frost and Sullivan Freitas A.R. 2005. Current status of Nanomedicine and Medical nanorobotics, Journal of Computational and Theoretical Nanoscience . 2: 1–25. 194 195 Logothetidis S. 2006. Nanotechnology in Medicine:The Medicine of Tomorrow and Nanomedicine.HIPPOKRATIA . 10 ,(1): 7-21. McCabe E. 2010. Nanopediatrics: Enabling Personalized Medicine for Children, Pediatric Research . 67, (5): 453-457. Desai T, Chu W, Tu J, Beattie G, Hayek A and Ferrari M. 1998. Microfabricated immunoisolating biocapsule Biotechnol.Bioeng. 1998,57: 118-120 . Deamer D and Akeson M.2000. Nanopores and nucleic acids: prospects for ultrarapid sequencing.Trends Biotechnol. 18, (4): 147-151. Shi H and Ratner B. 2000.Template recognition of protein imprinted polymer surfaces, J. Biomed. Mater. Res. 49: 1-11. Oshikawa M . 2001. Molecularly imprinted polymeric membranes Bioseparation 10,6: 277- 286 . Bruggemann O. 2002. Molecularly imprinted materials –receptors more durable than nature can provide Adv. Biochem. Eng. Biotechnol. 76, 127-163 . Wu X, Liu H, Liu J, Haley K, Treadway J, Larson J, Ge N, Peale F. 2003. Immunofluorescent labeling of cancer marker Her2 and other cellular targets with semiconductor quantum dots. Nat. Biotechnol.21 :41-46 . Medintz I, Clapp A, Mattoussi H, Goldman E, Fisher B , and Mauro J. Self .2003. assembled nanoscale biosensors based on quantum dot FRET donors . Nat. Mater. 2: 630- 638 . Han M, Gao X, Su J, and Nie S. 2001. Quantum-Dot-Tagged Microbeads for Multiplexed Optical Coding of Biomolecules Nat. Biotechnol.19: 631 . Gerion D, Parak J, Williams S, Zanchet D, Micheel C, Alivisatos A, Larabel C. 2002. Cell motility and metastatic potential studiesbased on Quantum dot imaging of phakokinetic Tracks Adv mater.14 :882-885 . Okumasu F and Dvorak J. 2003. Development and application of quantum dots for immunocytochemistry of human erythrocytes. J. Microsc.11 :256-61 . Gao X, Chan C, and Nie S.2002 . Quantum-dot nano crystals for ultrasensitive biological labelling and multicolour optical encoding J. Biomed. Opt. 7 :532-537. 195 196 Schinazi R, Sijbesma R, Srdano G, Hill C, and Wudl F.1993 . Synthesis and virucidal activity of a water-soluble, configurationally stable, derivatized C60 fulleren Antimicrob. Agents Chemother. 37:1707-1710. Freitas A.R. 2005. “Microbivores: Artificial Mechanical Phagocytes Using Digest and Discharge Protocol,” j evolu tech .14(4):56-106 Wang Z, Liub H, Yang S.2012 .Nanoparticle-based artificial RNA silencing machinery for antiviral therapy. Proc. Natl Acad. Sci. USA. 10:1073 Shukla R, Chanda N, Zambre A .2012 . Laminin receptor specific therapeutic gold nanoparticles (198AuNP-EGCg) show efficacy in treating prostate cancer. Proc. Natl Acad. Sci. USA .109(31): 12426–12431. Park J, Wrzesinski S, Stern E . 2012 .Combination delivery of TGF-b inhibitor and IL-2 by nanoscale liposomal polymeric gels enhances tumour immunotherapy. Nat. Mater. 11:895 196 197 Journal of Today’s Biological Sciences: Research & Review (JTBSRR) ISSN 2320-1444 (Online) JTBSRR Vol.1, Issue 1, page 197-209, December 30, 2012 Available on: www.jtbsrr.in Biofuels: Potential, Current Issues and Future Trends Pratap V. Naikwade*, Ranjit P. Bansode* & Sagar T. Sankpal1 *Department of Botany, Nya. Tyatyasahe Aathalye Arts, Ved. S. R. Sapre Commerce and Vid. Dadasaheb Pitre Science College, Devrukh-415804, Maharashtra, India. *Department of Chemistry, Nya. Tyatyasahe Aathalye Arts, Ved. S. R. Sapre Commerce and Vid. Dadasaheb Pitre Science College, Devrukh-415804, Maharashtra, India. E- mail of corresponding author: naikwade.pratap@gmail.com Abstract Biofuels are renewable liquid fuels coming from biological raw material and have been proved to be good substitutes for oil in the transportation sector. Biofuels such as ethanol and biodiesel are gaining worldwide acceptance as a solution to energy security, reducing imports and improving agricultural economy. Bio fuels are to reduce negative environmental effects through lower emissions and climatic impacts. Local production of bio energy is projected to have a broad range of positive economic, social and environmental implications. India is sixth in the world in energy demand accounting for 3.5% of world commercial energy consumption. Indian petrol reserves are expected to last for another 20 years plus. There is more potential for biodiesel to be produced on a smaller scale, it requires the least economies of scale and has the greatest potential to benefit small farmers and rural development. Europe, Brazil, China and India each have targets to replace 5% to 20% of total diesel with biodiesel. It is possible that Biodiesel could represent as much as 20% of all on-road diesel used in Brazil, Europe, China and India by the year 2020 with the pursuit of second generation, non-food feed stocks. Present study reveals potential of biofuel as solution of environmental problems, energy security and many other issues. It also focuses on current issues and bright future trends of biofuel as it is getting significant importance globally due to growing world energy demand, the insecurity of long-term supply and the consequences of fossil fuel use for climate change. Key words: biofuel, environment, future, global market, potential. 197 198 Introduction Biofuels are renewable liquid fuels coming from biological raw material and have been proved to be good substitutes for oil in the transportation sector. As such biofuels – ethanol and biodiesel- are gaining worldwide acceptance as a solution to environmental problems, energy security, reducing imports, rural employment and improving agricultural economy (Wilson et al.,2005). Biofuel as an alternative fuel is becoming increasingly important due to diminishing petroleum reserves and the environmental consequences of exhaust gases from petroleum-fuelled engines. Biodiesel, which is made from renewable sources, consists of the simple alkyl esters of fatty acids (Wilson et al., 2005). As a future prospective fuel, biodiesel has to compete economically with petroleum diesel fuels (Ma and Hanna, 1999). One way of reducing the biodiesel production costs is to use the less expensive feedstock containing fatty acids such as inedible oils, animal fats, waste food oil and byproducts of the refining vegetables oils (Veljkovic et al., 2006). The availability and sustainability of sufficient supplies of less expensive feedstock will be a crucial determinant delivering a competitive biodiesel to the commercials filling stations. Fortunately, inedible vegetable oils, mostly produced by seed-bearing trees and shrubs can provide an alternative (Shay, 1993). Biofuels are solution to issues such as sustainable development, energy security and a reduction of greenhouse gas emissions etc. Biodiesel is a methyl or ethyl ester of fatty acid made from renewable biological resources such as vegetable oils recycled waste vegetable oil and animal fats (Demirbas, 2000; Kinney and Clemente, 2005). The use of vegetable oils as alternative fuels has been around since 1900 when the inventor of the diesel engine Rudolph Diesel first tested peanut oil in his compression ignition engine (Shay, 1993). However, due to cheap petroleum products such non-conventional fuels never took off until recently. Biodiesel derived from surplus edible oils like soybean, sunflower and rapeseed oils is already being used in USA and Europe to reduce air pollution, to reduce dependence on depleting fossil fuel localised in specific regions of the world and increases in crude oil prices (Berchmans and Hirata, 2008; Foidl et al., 1996). The main commodity sources for bio-diesel in India can be non-edible oils obtained from plant species such as Jatropha curcas, Pongamia pinnata, Calophyllum inophyllum, Hevca brasiliensis etc. Bio-diesel contains no petroleum, but it can be blended at any level with petroleum diesel to create a bio-diesel blend or can be used in its pure form. The use of bio-diesel in conventional diesel engines results in substantial reduction of un-burnt hydrocarbons, carbon monoxide and particulate matters. Bio-diesel is considered clean fuel since it has almost no 198 199 sulphur, no aromatics and has about 10 % built- in oxygen, which helps it to burn fully (Sarin et al., 2007). The use of edible oil to produce biodiesel in India and other developing countries is not feasible in view of a huge gap between demand and supply of such oils in the developing world. In Asia and Africa, which are mostly net importers of vegetable oil, Jatropha curcas has been recognised as new energy crop for the countries to grow their own renewable energy source with many promising benefits (Pramanik, 2003). Advantages of biodiesel 1. Produced from sustainable / renewable biological sources 2. Ecofriendly and oxygenated fuel 3. Biodiesel has higher flash point for safety 4. It will provide income to rural community 5. Non toxic and safety to handle 6. Fuel properties similar to the conventional fuel 7. Blending of biodiesel with diesel fuel increases engine efficiency. 8. Used in existing unmodified diesel engines 9. Reduce expenditure on oil imports 10. Biodiesel degrades four times faster than diesel. 11. Sulphur free, less CO, HC, particulate matter and aromatic compounds emissions 12. Biodiesel is carbon neutral because the balance between the amount of CO2 emissions and the amount of CO2 absorbed by the plants producing vegetable oil is equal. Current trends The first significant large-scale push for the production and use of biofuels occurred in Brazil and the United States, as a response to the 1973 oil export embargo imposed by the Arab members of OPEC (Organization of the Petroleum Exporting Countries) against Japan, the United States and Western European countries (Walter,2006). The export restriction resulted in a dramatic increase of oil prices, from $3 to $12 per barrel. The United States invested in biofuels as a way to address the fuel shortages induced by the embargo and to reduce dependence on imported oil. Brazil’s objective was to reduce the pressure on its balance of payments due to the rising cost of fossil fuel imports. At present biofuels are once again at the centre stage of the debate on energy due to high and volatile oil prices and oil supply instability. In addition, a strong global consensus nowadays advocates for reductions in GHG emissions as a crucial step 199 200 to combat rising global temperatures. Governments seeking to curb emissions are now promoting biofuels because of their potentially cleaner emissions profile as compared to fossil fuels (Tyner and Taheripour,2007). Biodiesel is formed chemically by trans-esterification of vegetable oils obtained by physical and/or chemical separation from oilseed crops (Connor and Hernandez, 2008). Bioethanol is produced by fermentation of glucose and fructose, which are easily obtained from sucrose crops such as sugarcane or sugar beet. Bioethanol can also be made from cellulose, also but with a different chemical bonding to starch (Badger, 2002). Currently, raw material used for producing ethanol varies from sugar, cereals, sugar beet to molasses in India. Brazil uses ethanol as 100 % fuel in about 20 per cent of vehicles and 25% blend with gasoline in the rest of the vehicles. USA uses 10 % ethanol-gasoline blends whereas a 5% blend is used in Sweden. Australia uses 10% ethanol- gasoline blend. Use of 5% ethanol- gasoline blend is already approved by BIS and is in progressive state of implementation in the country. Biodiesel and bioethanol are produced from a small range of crops provide essentially all renewable liquid transport fuels. Other liquid fuels, such as synthetic gasoline and diesel, play minor roles. However, non-liquid transport fuels, including biogas, hydrogen, and electricity, can also be produced from biomass. Maize (USA), and sugarcane (Brazil) provide the bulk of feedstock for bioethanol production, currently at 1090 PJ per year or 52 billion liters (FAO, 2008). Other crops (e.g. sugar beet, wheat, barley, cassava, potato, and rice) are also used in various countries. The dominant crop for biodiesel production, currently 340 PJ per year or 10 billion liters (FAO, 2008), is rapeseed (i.e. canola) (EU), although oil palm (Malaysia and Indonesia), soybean (USA and Brazil), and sunflower (Eastern Europe) are gaining importance. (Liska and Cassman, 2008), Peanut, cotton, sesame, and coconut are also used as feedstock. Sunflower and rapeseed are the raw materials used in Europe whereas soybean is used in USA. Thailand uses palm oil, Ireland uses frying oil and animal fats. It is proposed to use nonedible oil for making biodiesel. The current installed production capacity will not be sufficient to cover the demand induced (Espey, 1996). For almost all the countries analyzed, there is a gap between the potential demand generated by mandatory or voluntary blending targets and their production capacity. Therefore additional production will be needed to fulfill the mandates and reduce the pressure on biofuel prices. Effect on food due to biofuel crop production India has total geographical area of 328 million hectares out of which around 142 million hectares is used for agriculture. By 2030 Indian population is expected to 200 201 rise to 1.5 billion from around 1.1 billion presently. To feed this much number even with very conservative estimates will require around 185 Million hectares of agricultural land with an assumption that the land productivity remains same. Promotion of biofuels at the cost of rise of food products may have catastrophic results on the Indian social equity and peace. For food security we should focus on the increased use of waste land to promote environment friendly biofuels. High speed diesel is the largest consumed petro-product in India on account of better mileage, power and lower administered price compared to petrol (Kumar et al., 2008a). Mass utilization of diesel in India imposes a threat to meeting the future energy needs, if the unexpected volatilities in the price of petroleum persists in future and government of India enforces oil marketing companies to sell diesel at uncapped price. It’s demand is expected to raise up to 100 million tones with an assumption of 6% per annum growth rate on very conservative basis by 2020. With an approximate import dependency of 90%, energy security favours the adoption of 20% blending by Jatropha biodiesel. Production of 31.4 million tonnes of Jatropha biodiesel i.e. is 20% of total diesel requirement will require about 26 million hectares of land by 2020. When we are considering key macro-indicators of India, it shows that with the growth in population, per capita food intake and energy requirement has also increased. Increased population may result in food vs fuel conflict. Apprehensions have been expressed that the cultivators may willingly opt for such crops, which may be used for producing biofuels and may be more remunerative in shorter terms. Farming process itself is an energy intensive activity requiring power for irrigation, ploughing and processing of farming produce. Biofuel and green house gas policies It is widely believed that the biofuels industry has an exclusive role in climate policy because it represents a low-carbon alternative to fossil fuels. GHG (green house gas) policies that create an emissions trading system such as the cap and trade mechanism can also stimulate the production of biofuels by imposing a cap on carbon emissions and allowing trade of emissions permits (allowances). In practice, such a system creates a price for carbon, similarly to the imposition of a tax on GHG emissions. There are two main approaches to create tradable emissions reductions (Ellerman, 2000). The first is a cap and trade system in which a central authority sets a limit or cap on the amount of a pollutant that can be emitted. Second approach is a baseline and credit system. Polluters not under an aggregate cap can create credits by reducing their emissions below a baseline level of emissions. These credits can be purchased by polluters that are under a regulatory limit. 201 202 The main international agreement currently addressing GHG mitigation is the Kyoto Protocol (United Nations Framework Convention on Climate Change (UNFCCC), 1997). Under this agreement, 37 industrialized countries and the European Community are committed to reduce their overall emissions of greenhouse gases by at least 5 per cent below 1990 levels during the period 2008– 2012. Biofuel is considered a low-carbon emissions fuel, and therefore a biofuel production project is a potential candidate for eligibility under the CDM or Joint Implementation mechanisms of Kyoto Protocol. On the other hand even without explicit GHG markets that allow for CO2 credits, the demand for biofuels is likely to expand unless another low-carbon alternative in the transportation sector emerges. There are also supplementary benefits from carbon sequestration and emissions reductions. Emissions reductions by fuel switching may reduce the emissions of other air pollutants (Matus et al., 2008) and carbon sequestration may reduce soil erosion and leaching agricultural chemicals, thereby reducing water pollution (Marland et al., 2001). If biofuels replace row crops or severely degraded grazing land, this could result in benefits in terms of reduced soil erosion or reduced use of chemicals pesticides. However, sustained production of biofuels would likely require fertilizer inputs, generating the negative externality of N2O emissions from nitrogen fertilizer. The establishment of a carbon dioxide (CO2) price creates incentives for the development of a global biofuels market either directly through enticements to substitute biofuels for fossil fuel use in countries with greenhouse gas (GHG) policy or indirectly through the Clean Development Mechanism (CDM) of Kyoto protocol. So it is reasonable to assume that bioenergy production will increase even in the absence of climate policy. Opportunities for developing countries In general, developing countries have a larger potential to produce biomass and biofuel than industrialized countries due to better climate conditions and lower labour costs. Due to this international trade in biofuels and feedstocks from developing to developed countries is expected to increase with significant positive implications for development. This puts them in an ideal position to fully benefit from a new and dynamic sector of the world economy. Agriculture is an ecosystem-based activity, the major factor determining agriculture’s productive capacity is the natural endowment (De La Torre Ugarte, 2007). Global biomass supply estimates from plantations range from 47 to 238 EJ/year, with over 80 per cent coming from developing nations (Berndes et al., 2003). Fischer and Schrattenhozer (2001) estimate that 34 per cent of global bioenergy could come from developing nation plantations, with 687 Mha in Africa, 400 Mha in Asia and 307 Mha in Latin America. Developing countries are also significant sources of forest biomass, with Sorensen (1999) indicating that Latin American 202 203 and sub- Saharan Africa are the greatest potential sources. The expansion of biofuels is closely linked to the productive capacity of the agricultural sector and to its ability to provide food, feed, fibre and energy feedstocks simultaneously. A crucial determinant of the agricultural productive capacity of a country is given by its endowment of natural resources, while investment in research and development and in infrastructure has the ability to enhance this potential. Innovative Biofuels New and innovative biofuels are expected to contribute to efforts to reduce net greenhouse gas emissions, improve energy security and aid development, For development of new biofuels some properties are focused as it can be produced without harming the environment or local populations, It will not cause negative effect on food production, It will need minimal resources, such as water and land, it can be processed efficiently to yield high-quality liquid biofuels; and deliverable in sufficient quantities. Some of the new biofuels are lignocellulosic biofuels, algal biofuels, electrofuels (use microoganisms typically bacteria to directly utilize energy from electricity and do not need solar energy to grow or produce biofuels), thermochemically generated fuels etc. Lignocellulosic biofuels Lignocellulosic biofuels use all of the plant instead of just the starch or sugary parts. Residue products from arable food agriculture, such as straw, could be used as feedstocks. In this way, food crop plants could become effectively dualuse, producing both food and fuel (Banerjee et al.,2010). A second option is to use plants grown solely for the production of lignocellulosic biofuels, such as trees and grasses (e.g. willow, poplar, switchgrass and miscanthus). In addition to the greater utilisation of biomass compared with biofuels produced from food crops, there is significant potential to improve feedstock characteristics such as yields, water use, and pest and frost resistance using advanced plant breeding strategies and genetic modification. However, technology in this field is mostly still at the research and development stage. Moreover, lignocellulosic biofuels require more sophisticated processing than current biofuels, and this is currently very costly (Weng et al.,2008). However, given further technological advances, there are options to improve efficiency and bring down costs significantly. An additional issue with agricultural residues is their limited supply. As straw can be used to provide organic amendment to soil to maintain good soil condition, some suggest that a maximum of only 40 per cent of straw should be used in ethanol production or other industrial purposes (Lafond et al.,2009) 203 204 Algal biofuels Algae constitute a diverse group of aquatic photosynthetic organisms that produce an equally diverse range of chemicals, including an array of oils that can be used to produce biodiesel, avoiding some of the technical challenges of converting lignocellulose to liquid fuels. They do not require freshwater and can be cultivated in wastewater or sea water, and it is expected that under optimal conditions they will produce high yields. Algae can be cultivated in open ponds or closed photobioreactors, or in hybrid systems (Chisti, 2007). Currently, the production of algal biofuels is experimental, and costs are very high. There is significant potential for improvements of feedstocks and processing, for example using genetic modification or synthetic biology. The production of algal-based biofuels (ABBs) sometimes referred to as third generation biofuels Using algal oils produces algal biodiesel which is similar in chemical and physical properties to diesel derived from fossil oil and which compares well with the international biodiesel standard for biodiesel use in vehicles (Brennan and Owende, 2010). In comparison with diesel, algal biodiesel is non-toxic and has reduced levels of particulates, carbon monoxide, soot, hydrocarbons and sulphur oxides. It is also cited as being more suitable for aviation use than first generation biodiesel, having a low freezing point and high energy density (Greenwell et al.,2010). Global market of biofuels With the price of fossil oil surging above the historical mark of US$ 100 a barrel in the year 2007/2008 the search for alternative energy sources has become more urgent than ever. The global market for biodiesel is poised for explosive growth in future years. Although Europe currently represents 80% of global biodiesel consumption and production, the U.S. is now ramping up production at a faster rate than Europe and Brazil is expected to surpass U.S. and European biodiesel production by the year 2015. It is possible that Biodiesel could represent as much as 20% of all on-road diesel used in Brazil, Europe, China and India by the year 2020 with the pursuit of second generation, non-food feed stocks. Biodiesel demand and over-capacity in Europe, the US and Asia is driving investment in the global trade of alternative feeds tocks. In China, India, Brazil and Europe, economic and environmental security concerns are giving birth to new government targets and incentives, aimed at reducing petroleum imports and increasing the consumption and production of renewable fuels. Europe, Brazil, China and India each have targets to replace 5% to 20% of total diesel with biodiesel. If governments continue to aggressively pursue targets for second generation fuels; and continue to promote research and development in investment in alternative, non-food feedstocks such as grease tallow, Jatropha, 204 205 Castor, algae, and renewable diesel, the prospects for biodiesel will be realized faster than anticipated. It is estimated that the United States produces 44%, Brazil 41%, the European Union 13% and South East Asia 2% of the world‘s total supply of biofuel, which is about 16Mtoe (million ton oil equivalent comprising 80% ethanol and 20% biodiesel) (Prota, 2007). The world biofuels market has been growing at an accelerated pace in the last twenty years, and this trend is expected to continue in the future. International trade The world market of biofuels has been steadily growing in the last years, with an increasing number of countries participating in it for environmental and security reasons. In 2002 world production of ethanol reached 21,841 million liters, while biodiesel production was 1,503 million liters. This production not only provided an alternative to fossil fuel, but it is also generated large number of employment since biofuel production requires 100 times more workers per unit of energy produced than fossil fuels. In 2002, the ethanol industry provided more than 200,000 jobs in the US and ½ million direct jobs in Brazil (IEA, 2004). In recent years, Jatropha curcas has become the focus of large planting programmes in several tropical countries on account of its potential as a bio-fuel crop with low agro-ecological demands. Most of these are still in pilot stage of development, together probably not exceeding 100,000 ha. India alone may have more than 10 million ha of small-scale and large plantation by 2030, mostly reclaimed wastelands. There are many crops that can be used for producing biodiesel, but the choice normally depends on local availability, affordability and government incentives. Both India and China have large Jatropha plantations under development. In addition, China is investigating recycled cooking oil as an option. Since biofuels can be produced from a diverse set of crops each country is adopting a strategy that exploits the comparative advantages it holds in certain crops. India has launched a National Mission on Biofuels, the main strategy of which has been to promote Jatropha Curcas; a perennial shrub that bears non edible oil seeds that can be used to produce biodiesel. Many biofuel crops are used for extraction of biodiesel. In terms of the market size, the biodiesel industry reached 3,524 million liters in 2005, with Western Europe having the largest share of the market. Although it is still the largest producer, market fragmentation has decreased Western Europe‘s monopoly in the biodiesel market. Its share which represented 95% of the market in 2000, had been reduced to approximately 80% by 2005. This is accounted by new players, such as Asia, entering into the market. 205 206 Conclusion Use of biofuels has significant importance globally as the world addresses changing patterns in energy supply and demand. Biofuels have potential to solve issues as green house effects, carbon sequestration, growing world energy demand, the insecurity of long-term supply and the consequences of fossil fuel. Production of biofuels will help developing countries by reducing imports and improving agricultural economy and subsequently poverty reduction. Many countries are promoting the production and use of biofuels - energy extracted as gas, liquid or oil from plants. Biofuel derived from food crops such as corn, sugarcane, soybean, oil palm and sugarbeet has been on the rise in recent years. The use of non food crops as Jatropha curcas, Pongamia pinnata etc. is also promoted. In future innovative biofues such as lignocellulosic biofuels, algal biofuels, electrofuels will have bright future. The world biofuel market has been growing at an accelerated pace in the last twenty years and this trend is expected to continue in the future due to increasing number of countries participating in it for environmental and security reasons. Biofuels have the potential to meet more than a quarter of world demand for transportation fuels by 2050. Social awareness is needed on production and usage of biofuels as an alternative to petroleum based fuels. References Badger, P.C., 2002. Ethanol from cellulose: a general review. P. 17-21 In Proceedings of the Fifth National Symposium, Atlanta, Georgia, USA, ASHS Press, Alexandria, VA., USA. Banerjee, S., Mudliar, S. Sen, R., 2010. Commercializing lignocellulosic bioethanol: technology bottlenecks and possible remedies Biofuels, Bioproducts & Biorefining 4: 77-93. Berchmans, H.J. and Hirata, S., 2008, Biodiesel production from crude Jatropha curcas L. seed oil with a high content of free fatty acids. Bioresource Technology, 99,1716-1721. Berndes, G., Hoogwijk, M., & van den Broek, R., 2003. The contribution of biomass in the future global energy supply: a review of 17 studies. Biomass and Bioenergy. 25: 1–28. Brennan, L. and Owende, P., 2010. Biofuels from microalgae: a review of technologies for production, processing, and extractions of biofuels and co206 207 products Renewable and Sustainable Energy Reviews 14: 557-77. Chisti, Y., 2007. Biodiesel from microalgae Biotechnology Advances 25: 294-306. Connor, D.J. and Hernandez, C.G., 2008. Crops for Biofuel: Current Status and Prospects for the Future, Biofuels: Environmental Consequences and Interactions with Changing Land Use, Proceedings of the Scientific Committee on Problems of the Environment (SCOPE) International Biofuels Project Rapid Assessment Gummersbach, Germany, 65-80 De La Torre Ugarte D. and Dellachiesa, A., 2007. Advancing the agricultural trade agenda: beyond subsidies. The Georgetown International Environmental Law Review. 19 (4). Demirbas, A., 2000. Conversion of biomass using glycerine to liquid fuel for blending gasoline as alternative engine fuel. Energy Convers. Manage. 41: 17411748. Ellerman, A.D., Joskow, P. L., Schmalensee, R.,Montero, J.P. and Bailey, E. 2000. Markets for Clean Air: The U.S. Acid Rain Program. Cambridge, Cambridge University Press. Espey, M., 1996. Explaining the variation in elasticity estimates of gasoline demand in the United States Meta-analysis. 17 (3): 49–60. FAO (Food and Agriculture Organization of the United Nations), 2008. The state of food and agriculture. FAO, Rome, Italy. Fischer, G. and Schrattenholzer, L., 2001. Global bioenergy potentials through 2050. Biomass and Bioenergy. 20: 151–159. Foidl, N., Foidl, G., Sanchez, M., Mittelbach, M., Hackel, S., 1996. Jatropha curcas L. as a resource for the production of biofuel in Nicaragua. Bioresour. Technol., 58: 77-82. Greenwell, H.C., Laurens, L.M.L., Shields, R.J., Lovitt, R.W. and Flynn, K.J. (2010) Placing microalgae on the biofuels priority list: a review of the technological challenges, Journal of the Royal Society Interface 7: 703-26. International Energy Agency (IEA, 2004). Biofuels for Transport: An International Perspective. OECD. Kinney, A.J. and Clemente, T.E., 2005. Modifying soybean oil for enhanced 207 208 performance in biodiesel blends. Fuel Process Technol. 86: 1137- 1147. Kumar, S., Chaube, A., Jain, S.K.,2008. Indian J Applied Life Sc, 4, 1&2, 1-5. Lafond, G.P., Stumborg, M., Lemke, R., 2009. Quantifying straw removal through baling and measuring the long-term impact on soil quality and wheat production Agronomy Journal 101: 529-37. Liska, A.J. and Cassman. K.G., 2008. Towards standardization of life-cycle metrics for biofuels: greenhouse gas emissions mitigation and net energy yield. J. Biobased Materials. 2: 187-203. Ma, F. and Hanna, M.A., 1999. Biodiesel Production: a review. Bioresour. Technol., 70: 1-15. Marland, G., McCarl, B.A. and Schneider, U.,2001. Soil carbon: policy and economics. Climatic Change 51:101-117. Matus, K., Yang, T. Paltsev, S. Reilly, J. and Nam, K.M., 2008. Toward integrated assessment of environmental change: air pollution health effects in USA. Climatic Change. 88 (1): 59–92. Pramanik, K., 2003. Properties and use of Jatropha curcas oil and diesel fuel blends in compression ignition engine. Int. J. Renew. Energy. 28: 239-248. Prota , 2007. Vegetable oils as feedstock for biodiesel in Africa. Prota Newsletter. No. 6. Sarin, R., Sharma, M., Sinharay, S., Malhotra, R.K., 2007. Jatropha-Palm biodiesel blends: An optimum mix for Asia. Fuel 86: 1365-1371.. Shay, E.G., 1993. Diesel fuel from vegetable oil: Status and opportunities. Biomass Bioenerg. 4: 227-242. Sorensen, B., 1999. Long-term scenarios for global energy demand and supply: four global greenhouse mitigation scenarios. Roskilde University, Institute 2, Energy and Environment Group. Tyner, W.E. and Taheripour, F., 2007. Future biofuels policy alternatives. Paper presented at Biofuels, Food, & Feed Tradeoffs Conference. St. Louis. UNFCCC., 1997. The Kyoto Protocol. Bonn, Climate Change Secretariat. 208 209 Veljkovic, V.B., Lakicevic, S.H., Stamenkovic, O.S., Todorovic, Z.B., Lazic, K.L., 2006. Biodiesel production from tobacco (Nicotiana tabacum L.) seed oil with a high content of free fatty acids. Fuel 85, 2671–2675. Walter, A., 2006. Biomass energy and bio-energy trade: historic developments in brazil and current opportunities, country report: Brazil – EIA/Task 40 – Sustainable bio-energy trade; securing supply and demand. Weng, J.K., Li, X., Bonawitz, N.D. and Chapple, C. 2008. Emerging strategies of lignin engineering and degradation for cellulosic biofuel production Current Opinion in Biotechnology 19: 166-72. Wilson, S.C., Mathews, M., Austin, G., von Blottnitz, H., 2005. Review of the status of biodiesel related activities in South Africa. Report for the City of Cape Town, South Africa p. 76. 209